blob: ea18d562b436d5cf539e3586984e397f6f0efc3b [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00001//===--- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes ------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements the ASTContext interface.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000015#include "CXXABI.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000016#include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
17#include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +000018#include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000019#include "clang/AST/Comment.h"
Dmitri Gribenkoca7f80a2012-08-09 00:03:17 +000020#include "clang/AST/CommentCommandTraits.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
Steve Naroff67391b82007-10-01 19:00:59 +000022#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorded2d7b2009-02-04 19:02:06 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +000024#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h"
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +000027#include "clang/AST/Mangle.h"
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +000028#include "clang/AST/MangleNumberingContext.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000029#include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +000030#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000031#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +000032#include "clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h"
Chris Lattner15ba9492009-06-14 01:54:56 +000033#include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
Chris Lattnerd2868512009-03-28 03:45:20 +000034#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner4dc8a6f2007-05-20 23:50:58 +000035#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000036#include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +000037#include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +000038#include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000039#include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h"
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +000040#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000041#include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +000042#include <map>
Anders Carlssona4267a62009-07-18 21:19:52 +000043
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +000044using namespace clang;
45
Douglas Gregor9672f922010-07-03 00:47:00 +000046unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructors;
47unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregora6d69502010-07-02 23:41:54 +000048unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructors;
49unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000050unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructors;
51unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor330b9cf2010-07-02 21:50:04 +000052unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators;
53unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000054unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators;
55unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +000056unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructors;
57unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared;
58
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000059enum FloatingRank {
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +000060 HalfRank, FloatRank, DoubleRank, LongDoubleRank
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000061};
62
Dmitri Gribenkof26054f2012-07-11 21:38:39 +000063RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000064 if (!CommentsLoaded && ExternalSource) {
65 ExternalSource->ReadComments();
Dmitri Gribenko9ee0e302014-03-27 15:40:39 +000066
67#ifndef NDEBUG
68 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
69 assert(std::is_sorted(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
70 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment>(SourceMgr)));
71#endif
72
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000073 CommentsLoaded = true;
74 }
75
76 assert(D);
77
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000078 // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations.
79 if (D->isImplicit())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000080 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000081
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000082 // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations.
83 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
84 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000085 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000086 }
87
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000088 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
89 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
90 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000091 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000092 }
93
94 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
95 if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000096 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000097 }
98
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +000099 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
100 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
101 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind();
102 if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
103 TSK == TSK_Undeclared)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000104 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000105 }
106
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000107 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
108 if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000109 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000110 }
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000111 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
112 // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the
113 // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment
114 if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000115 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000116 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000117 // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly.
118 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000119 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000120
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000121 // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template
122 // documentation.
123 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) ||
124 isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) ||
125 isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000126 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000127
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000128 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000129
130 // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything.
131 if (RawComments.empty())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000132 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000133
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000134 // Find declaration location.
135 // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple
136 // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration
137 // location".
138 // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently,
139 // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location".
140 SourceLocation DeclLoc;
141 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000142 isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko7f4b3772012-08-02 20:49:51 +0000143 isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) ||
144 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D))
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000145 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000146 else {
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000147 DeclLoc = D->getLocation();
Dmitri Gribenkoef099dc2014-03-27 16:40:51 +0000148 if (DeclLoc.isMacroID()) {
149 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
150 // If location of the typedef name is in a macro, it is because being
151 // declared via a macro. Try using declaration's starting location as
152 // the "declaration location".
153 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
154 } else if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
155 // If location of the tag decl is inside a macro, but the spelling of
156 // the tag name comes from a macro argument, it looks like a special
157 // macro like NS_ENUM is being used to define the tag decl. In that
158 // case, adjust the source location to the expansion loc so that we can
159 // attach the comment to the tag decl.
160 if (SourceMgr.isMacroArgExpansion(DeclLoc) &&
161 TD->isCompleteDefinition())
162 DeclLoc = SourceMgr.getExpansionLoc(DeclLoc);
163 }
164 }
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000165 }
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000166
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000167 // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
168 // can't find the comment.
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000169 if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000170 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000171
172 // Find the comment that occurs just after this declaration.
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000173 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator Comment;
174 {
175 // When searching for comments during parsing, the comment we are looking
176 // for is usually among the last two comments we parsed -- check them
177 // first.
Dmitri Gribenkoa7d16ce2013-04-10 15:35:17 +0000178 RawComment CommentAtDeclLoc(
179 SourceMgr, SourceRange(DeclLoc), false,
180 LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments);
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000181 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment> Compare(SourceMgr);
182 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator MaybeBeforeDecl = RawComments.end() - 1;
183 bool Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
184 if (!Found && RawComments.size() >= 2) {
185 MaybeBeforeDecl--;
186 Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
187 }
188
189 if (Found) {
190 Comment = MaybeBeforeDecl + 1;
191 assert(Comment == std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
192 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare));
193 } else {
194 // Slow path.
195 Comment = std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
196 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare);
197 }
198 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000199
200 // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the
201 // file buffer.
202 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc);
203
204 // First check whether we have a trailing comment.
205 if (Comment != RawComments.end() &&
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000206 (*Comment)->isDocumentation() && (*Comment)->isTrailingComment() &&
Fariborz Jahanianfad28542013-08-06 23:29:00 +0000207 (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D) ||
Fariborz Jahanian3ab62222013-08-07 16:40:29 +0000208 isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))) {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000209 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentBeginDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000210 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getBegin());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000211 // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts
212 // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration.
213 if (DeclLocDecomp.first == CommentBeginDecomp.first &&
214 SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second)
215 == SourceMgr.getLineNumber(CommentBeginDecomp.first,
216 CommentBeginDecomp.second)) {
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000217 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000218 }
219 }
220
221 // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment.
222 // Let's look at the previous comment.
223 if (Comment == RawComments.begin())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000224 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000225 --Comment;
226
227 // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment.
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000228 if (!(*Comment)->isDocumentation() || (*Comment)->isTrailingComment())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000229 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000230
231 // Decompose the end of the comment.
232 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentEndDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000233 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000234
235 // If the comment and the declaration aren't in the same file, then they
236 // aren't related.
237 if (DeclLocDecomp.first != CommentEndDecomp.first)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000238 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000239
240 // Get the corresponding buffer.
241 bool Invalid = false;
242 const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first,
243 &Invalid).data();
244 if (Invalid)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000245 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000246
247 // Extract text between the comment and declaration.
248 StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndDecomp.second,
249 DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndDecomp.second);
250
Dmitri Gribenko7e8729b2012-06-27 23:43:37 +0000251 // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between
252 // comment and declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb534d3a2013-07-26 18:38:12 +0000253 if (Text.find_first_of(";{}#@") != StringRef::npos)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000254 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000255
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000256 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000257}
258
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000259namespace {
260/// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to
261/// refer to the actual template.
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000262/// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template.
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000263const Decl *adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl *D) {
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000264 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000265 // Is this function declaration part of a function template?
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000266 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000267 return FTD;
268
269 // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation.
270 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
271 return D;
272
273 // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template?
274 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate())
275 return FTD;
276
277 // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
278 if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl =
279 FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction())
280 return MemberDecl;
281
282 return D;
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000283 }
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000284 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
285 // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class
286 // template?
287 if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
288 if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember())
289 return MemberDecl;
290
291 return D;
292 }
293 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
294 // Is this class declaration part of a class template?
295 if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
296 return CTD;
297
298 // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial
299 // specialization?
300 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
301 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) {
302 if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
303 return D;
304 llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *,
305 ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>
306 PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial();
307 return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl*>() ?
308 static_cast<const Decl*>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>()) :
309 static_cast<const Decl*>(
310 PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>());
311 }
312
313 // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
314 if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info =
315 CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo())
316 return Info->getInstantiatedFrom();
317
318 return D;
319 }
320 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
321 // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
322 if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum())
323 return MemberDecl;
324
325 return D;
326 }
327 // FIXME: Adjust alias templates?
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000328 return D;
329}
330} // unnamed namespace
331
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000332const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(
333 const Decl *D,
334 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const {
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000335 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000336
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000337 // Check whether we have cached a comment for this declaration already.
338 {
339 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
340 RedeclComments.find(D);
341 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
342 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000343 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
344 if (OriginalDecl)
345 *OriginalDecl = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000346 return Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000347 }
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000348 }
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000349 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000350
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000351 // Search for comments attached to declarations in the redeclaration chain.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000352 const RawComment *RC = nullptr;
353 const Decl *OriginalDeclForRC = nullptr;
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000354 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000355 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000356 RedeclComments.find(I);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000357 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
358 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
359 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
360 RC = Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000361 OriginalDeclForRC = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000362 break;
363 }
364 } else {
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000365 RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(I);
366 OriginalDeclForRC = I;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000367 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
368 if (RC) {
369 Raw.setRaw(RC);
370 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromDecl);
371 } else
372 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl);
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000373 Raw.setOriginalDecl(I);
374 RedeclComments[I] = Raw;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000375 if (RC)
376 break;
377 }
378 }
379
Dmitri Gribenko5c8897d2012-06-28 16:25:36 +0000380 // If we found a comment, it should be a documentation comment.
381 assert(!RC || RC->isDocumentation());
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000382
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000383 if (OriginalDecl)
384 *OriginalDecl = OriginalDeclForRC;
385
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000386 // Update cache for every declaration in the redeclaration chain.
387 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
388 Raw.setRaw(RC);
389 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromRedecl);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000390 Raw.setOriginalDecl(OriginalDeclForRC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000391
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000392 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
393 RawCommentAndCacheFlags &R = RedeclComments[I];
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000394 if (R.getKind() == RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl)
395 R = Raw;
396 }
397
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000398 return RC;
399}
400
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000401static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod,
402 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) {
403 const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext();
404 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) {
405 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface();
406 if (!ID)
407 return;
408 // Add redeclared method here.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +0000409 for (const auto *Ext : ID->known_extensions()) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000410 if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod =
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +0000411 Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(),
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000412 ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod()))
413 Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod);
414 }
415 }
416}
417
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000418comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC,
419 const Decl *D) const {
420 comments::DeclInfo *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo;
421 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D;
422 ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false;
423 ThisDeclInfo->fill();
424 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7daabbd2014-04-27 22:53:03 +0000425 if (!ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters)
426 ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters = FC->getDeclInfo()->TemplateParameters;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000427 comments::FullComment *CFC =
428 new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(),
429 ThisDeclInfo);
430 return CFC;
431
432}
433
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000434comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl *D) const {
435 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(D);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000436 return RC ? RC->parse(*this, nullptr, D) : nullptr;
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000437}
438
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000439comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl(
440 const Decl *D,
441 const Preprocessor *PP) const {
Fariborz Jahanian096f7c12013-05-13 17:27:00 +0000442 if (D->isInvalidDecl())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000443 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000444 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000445
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000446 const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl();
447 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos =
448 ParsedComments.find(Canonical);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000449
450 if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000451 if (Canonical != D) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000452 comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000453 comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000454 return CFC;
455 }
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000456 return Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000457 }
458
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000459 const Decl *OriginalDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000460
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000461 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000462 if (!RC) {
463 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000464 SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden;
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000465 const ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000466 if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor())
467 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl())
468 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP))
469 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000470 if (OMD)
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000471 addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden);
472 getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000473 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++)
474 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP))
475 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000476 }
Fariborz Jahanian6384fbb2013-05-02 15:44:16 +0000477 else if (const TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000478 // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000479 // does not have one of its own.
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000480 QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType();
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000481 if (const TagType *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>())
482 if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl())
483 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP))
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000484 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000485 }
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000486 else if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
487 while (IC->getSuperClass()) {
488 IC = IC->getSuperClass();
489 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
490 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
491 }
492 }
493 else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) {
494 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface())
495 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
496 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
497 }
498 else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
499 if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000500 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000501 // Check non-virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000502 for (const auto &I : RD->bases()) {
503 if (I.isVirtual() || (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public))
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000504 continue;
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000505 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000506 if (Ty.isNull())
507 continue;
508 if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
509 if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition()))
510 continue;
511
512 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP))
513 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
514 }
515 }
516 // Check virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000517 for (const auto &I : RD->vbases()) {
518 if (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)
Fariborz Jahanian5a2e4a22013-04-26 23:34:36 +0000519 continue;
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000520 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000521 if (Ty.isNull())
522 continue;
523 if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
524 if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition()))
525 continue;
526 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP))
527 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
528 }
529 }
530 }
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000531 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000532 }
533
Dmitri Gribenkobfda9f72012-08-22 18:12:19 +0000534 // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we
535 // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl. This is important
536 // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be
537 // different across redeclarations.
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000538 if (D != OriginalDecl)
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000539 return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000540
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000541 comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D);
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000542 ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC;
543 return FC;
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000544}
545
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000546void
547ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
548 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) {
549 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth());
550 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition());
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000551 ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack());
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000552
553 TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters();
554 ID.AddInteger(Params->size());
555 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
556 PEnd = Params->end();
557 P != PEnd; ++P) {
558 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
559 ID.AddInteger(0);
560 ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack());
561 continue;
562 }
563
564 if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
565 ID.AddInteger(1);
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000566 ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000567 ID.AddPointer(NTTP->getType().getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000568 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
569 ID.AddBoolean(true);
570 ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000571 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
572 QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I);
573 ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
574 }
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000575 } else
576 ID.AddBoolean(false);
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000577 continue;
578 }
579
580 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P);
581 ID.AddInteger(2);
582 Profile(ID, TTP);
583 }
584}
585
586TemplateTemplateParmDecl *
587ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +0000588 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const {
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000589 // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter.
590 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
591 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, TTP);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000592 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000593 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical
594 = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
595 if (Canonical)
596 return Canonical->getParam();
597
598 // Build a canonical template parameter list.
599 TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters();
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000600 SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000601 CanonParams.reserve(Params->size());
602 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
603 PEnd = Params->end();
604 P != PEnd; ++P) {
605 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P))
606 CanonParams.push_back(
607 TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnarab3185b02011-03-06 15:48:19 +0000608 SourceLocation(),
609 SourceLocation(),
610 TTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000611 TTP->getIndex(), nullptr, false,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000612 TTP->isParameterPack()));
613 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000614 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
615 QualType T = getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType());
616 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
617 NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param;
618 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000619 SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes;
620 SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos;
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000621 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
622 ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I)));
623 ExpandedTInfos.push_back(
624 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back()));
625 }
626
627 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000628 SourceLocation(),
629 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000630 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000631 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000632 T,
633 TInfo,
634 ExpandedTypes.data(),
635 ExpandedTypes.size(),
636 ExpandedTInfos.data());
637 } else {
638 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000639 SourceLocation(),
640 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000641 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000642 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000643 T,
644 NTTP->isParameterPack(),
645 TInfo);
646 }
647 CanonParams.push_back(Param);
648
649 } else
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000650 CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
651 cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P)));
652 }
653
654 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP
655 = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
656 SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(),
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000657 TTP->getPosition(),
658 TTP->isParameterPack(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000659 nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000660 TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(),
661 SourceLocation(),
662 CanonParams.data(),
663 CanonParams.size(),
664 SourceLocation()));
665
666 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
667 Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000668 assert(!Canonical && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000669 (void)Canonical;
670
671 // Create the canonical template template parameter entry.
672 Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP);
673 CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos);
674 return CanonTTP;
675}
676
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000677CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000678 if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return nullptr;
John McCall86353412010-08-21 22:46:04 +0000679
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000680 switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000681 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM: // Same as Itanium at this level
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000682 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +0000683 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000684 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000685 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000686 return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this);
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000687 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Charles Davis6bcb07a2010-08-19 02:18:14 +0000688 return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this);
689 }
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +0000690 llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!");
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000691}
692
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000693static const LangAS::Map *getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo &T,
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000694 const LangOptions &LOpts) {
695 if (LOpts.FakeAddressSpaceMap) {
696 // The fake address space map must have a distinct entry for each
697 // language-specific address space.
698 static const unsigned FakeAddrSpaceMap[] = {
699 1, // opencl_global
700 2, // opencl_local
Peter Collingbournef44bdf92012-05-20 21:08:35 +0000701 3, // opencl_constant
702 4, // cuda_device
703 5, // cuda_constant
704 6 // cuda_shared
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000705 };
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000706 return &FakeAddrSpaceMap;
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000707 } else {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000708 return &T.getAddressSpaceMap();
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000709 }
710}
711
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000712static bool isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo &TI,
713 const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
714 switch (LangOpts.getAddressSpaceMapMangling()) {
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000715 case LangOptions::ASMM_Target:
716 return TI.useAddressSpaceMapMangling();
717 case LangOptions::ASMM_On:
718 return true;
719 case LangOptions::ASMM_Off:
720 return false;
721 }
NAKAMURA Takumi5c81ca42013-09-13 17:12:09 +0000722 llvm_unreachable("getAddressSpaceMapMangling() doesn't cover anything.");
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000723}
724
Douglas Gregor7018d5b2011-09-01 20:23:19 +0000725ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions& LOpts, SourceManager &SM,
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000726 IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels,
Alp Toker08043432014-05-03 03:46:04 +0000727 Builtin::Context &builtins)
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000728 : FunctionProtoTypes(this_()),
729 TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
730 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
731 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000732 GlobalNestedNameSpecifier(nullptr),
733 Int128Decl(nullptr), UInt128Decl(nullptr), Float128StubDecl(nullptr),
734 BuiltinVaListDecl(nullptr),
735 ObjCIdDecl(nullptr), ObjCSelDecl(nullptr), ObjCClassDecl(nullptr),
736 ObjCProtocolClassDecl(nullptr), BOOLDecl(nullptr),
737 CFConstantStringTypeDecl(nullptr), ObjCInstanceTypeDecl(nullptr),
738 FILEDecl(nullptr),
739 jmp_bufDecl(nullptr), sigjmp_bufDecl(nullptr), ucontext_tDecl(nullptr),
740 BlockDescriptorType(nullptr), BlockDescriptorExtendedType(nullptr),
741 cudaConfigureCallDecl(nullptr),
Douglas Gregor0f2a3602011-12-03 00:30:27 +0000742 NullTypeSourceInfo(QualType()),
743 FirstLocalImport(), LastLocalImport(),
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000744 SourceMgr(SM), LangOpts(LOpts),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000745 AddrSpaceMap(nullptr), Target(nullptr), PrintingPolicy(LOpts),
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000746 Idents(idents), Selectors(sels),
747 BuiltinInfo(builtins),
748 DeclarationNames(*this),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000749 ExternalSource(nullptr), Listener(nullptr),
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000750 Comments(SM), CommentsLoaded(false),
Dmitri Gribenkoacf2e782013-02-22 14:21:27 +0000751 CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000752 LastSDM(nullptr, 0)
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000753{
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000754 TUDecl = TranslationUnitDecl::Create(*this);
755}
756
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000757ASTContext::~ASTContext() {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000758 ReleaseParentMapEntries();
759
Ted Kremenekda4e0d32010-02-11 07:12:28 +0000760 // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects.
761 // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution?
762 ReleaseDeclContextMaps();
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +0000763
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000764 // Call all of the deallocation functions on all of their targets.
765 for (DeallocationMap::const_iterator I = Deallocations.begin(),
766 E = Deallocations.end(); I != E; ++I)
767 for (unsigned J = 0, N = I->second.size(); J != N; ++J)
768 (I->first)((I->second)[J]);
769
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000770 // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000771 // because they can contain DenseMaps.
772 for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*,
773 const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
774 I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; )
775 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
776 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
777 R->Destroy(*this);
778
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000779 for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
780 I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) {
781 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
782 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
783 R->Destroy(*this);
784 }
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000785
786 for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(),
787 AEnd = DeclAttrs.end();
788 A != AEnd; ++A)
789 A->second->~AttrVec();
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +0000790
Reid Kleckner588c9372014-02-19 23:44:52 +0000791 llvm::DeleteContainerSeconds(MangleNumberingContexts);
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000792}
Douglas Gregorf21eb492009-03-26 23:50:42 +0000793
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000794void ASTContext::ReleaseParentMapEntries() {
795 if (!AllParents) return;
796 for (const auto &Entry : *AllParents) {
797 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
798 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
799 } else {
800 assert(Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>());
801 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
802 }
803 }
804}
805
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000806void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void*), void *Data) {
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000807 Deallocations[Callback].push_back(Data);
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000808}
809
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000810void
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000811ASTContext::setExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr<ExternalASTSource> Source) {
812 ExternalSource = Source;
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000813}
814
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000815void ASTContext::PrintStats() const {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000816 llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n";
817 llvm::errs() << " " << Types.size() << " types total.\n";
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +0000818
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000819 unsigned counts[] = {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000820#define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0,
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000821#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
822#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
823 0 // Extra
824 };
Douglas Gregorb1fe2c92009-04-07 17:20:56 +0000825
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000826 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) {
827 Type *T = Types[i];
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000828 counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++;
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000829 }
830
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000831 unsigned Idx = 0;
832 unsigned TotalBytes = 0;
833#define TYPE(Name, Parent) \
834 if (counts[Idx]) \
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000835 llvm::errs() << " " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name \
836 << " types\n"; \
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000837 TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type); \
838 ++Idx;
839#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
840#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000841
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000842 llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n";
843
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +0000844 // Implicit special member functions.
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000845 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/"
846 << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors
847 << " implicit default constructors created\n";
848 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/"
849 << NumImplicitCopyConstructors
850 << " implicit copy constructors created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000851 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000852 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/"
853 << NumImplicitMoveConstructors
854 << " implicit move constructors created\n";
855 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
856 << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators
857 << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000858 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000859 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
860 << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators
861 << " implicit move assignment operators created\n";
862 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/"
863 << NumImplicitDestructors
864 << " implicit destructors created\n";
865
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000866 if (ExternalSource) {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000867 llvm::errs() << "\n";
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000868 ExternalSource->PrintStats();
869 }
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000870
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000871 BumpAlloc.PrintStats();
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000872}
873
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000874RecordDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitRecord(StringRef Name,
875 RecordDecl::TagKind TK) const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000876 SourceLocation Loc;
877 RecordDecl *NewDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000878 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
879 NewDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc,
880 Loc, &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000881 else
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000882 NewDecl = RecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc, Loc,
883 &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000884 NewDecl->setImplicit();
885 return NewDecl;
886}
887
888TypedefDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitTypedef(QualType T,
889 StringRef Name) const {
890 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
891 TypedefDecl *NewDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(
892 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), getTranslationUnitDecl(),
893 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Name), TInfo);
894 NewDecl->setImplicit();
895 return NewDecl;
896}
897
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000898TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000899 if (!Int128Decl)
900 Int128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(Int128Ty, "__int128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000901 return Int128Decl;
902}
903
904TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000905 if (!UInt128Decl)
906 UInt128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(UnsignedInt128Ty, "__uint128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000907 return UInt128Decl;
908}
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000909
Nico Webere1687c52013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000910TypeDecl *ASTContext::getFloat128StubType() const {
Nico Weber5b0b46f2013-06-21 01:29:36 +0000911 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus && "should only be called for c++");
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000912 if (!Float128StubDecl)
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000913 Float128StubDecl = buildImplicitRecord("__float128");
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000914
Nico Webere1687c52013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000915 return Float128StubDecl;
916}
917
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000918void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000919 BuiltinType *Ty = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BuiltinType(K);
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000920 R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0));
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000921 Types.push_back(Ty);
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000922}
923
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000924void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target) {
925 assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) &&
926 "Incorrect target reinitialization");
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000927 assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000928
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000929 this->Target = &Target;
930
931 ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target));
932 AddrSpaceMap = getAddressSpaceMap(Target, LangOpts);
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000933 AddrSpaceMapMangling = isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(Target, LangOpts);
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000934
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000935 // C99 6.2.5p19.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000936 InitBuiltinType(VoidTy, BuiltinType::Void);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000937
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000938 // C99 6.2.5p2.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000939 InitBuiltinType(BoolTy, BuiltinType::Bool);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000940 // C99 6.2.5p3.
Eli Friedman9ffd4a92009-06-05 07:05:05 +0000941 if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned)
Chris Lattnerb16f4552007-06-03 07:25:34 +0000942 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_S);
943 else
944 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_U);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000945 // C99 6.2.5p4.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000946 InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy, BuiltinType::SChar);
947 InitBuiltinType(ShortTy, BuiltinType::Short);
948 InitBuiltinType(IntTy, BuiltinType::Int);
949 InitBuiltinType(LongTy, BuiltinType::Long);
950 InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy, BuiltinType::LongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000951
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000952 // C99 6.2.5p6.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000953 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy, BuiltinType::UChar);
954 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy, BuiltinType::UShort);
955 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy, BuiltinType::UInt);
956 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy, BuiltinType::ULong);
957 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy, BuiltinType::ULongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000958
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000959 // C99 6.2.5p10.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000960 InitBuiltinType(FloatTy, BuiltinType::Float);
961 InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy, BuiltinType::Double);
962 InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy, BuiltinType::LongDouble);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +0000963
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +0000964 // GNU extension, 128-bit integers.
965 InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty, BuiltinType::Int128);
966 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty, BuiltinType::UInt128);
967
Hans Wennborg0d81e012013-05-10 10:08:40 +0000968 // C++ 3.9.1p5
969 if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType()))
970 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_S);
971 else // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned.
972 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_U);
973 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar)
974 WideCharTy = WCharTy;
975 else {
976 // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar).
977 WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType());
978 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +0000979
James Molloy36365542012-05-04 10:55:22 +0000980 WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType());
981
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +0000982 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
983 InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty, BuiltinType::Char16);
984 else // C99
985 Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type());
986
987 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
988 InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty, BuiltinType::Char32);
989 else // C99
990 Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type());
991
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +0000992 // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is
993 // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against
994 // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to
995 // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent
996 // expressions.
997 InitBuiltinType(DependentTy, BuiltinType::Dependent);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000998
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +0000999 // Placeholder type for functions.
1000 InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy, BuiltinType::Overload);
1001
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00001002 // Placeholder type for bound members.
1003 InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy, BuiltinType::BoundMember);
1004
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001005 // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects.
1006 InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy, BuiltinType::PseudoObject);
1007
John McCall31996342011-04-07 08:22:57 +00001008 // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients.
1009 InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy, BuiltinType::UnknownAny);
1010
John McCall8a6b59a2011-10-17 18:09:15 +00001011 // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts.
1012 InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy, BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast);
1013
Eli Friedman34866c72012-08-31 00:14:07 +00001014 // Placeholder type for builtin functions.
1015 InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy, BuiltinType::BuiltinFn);
1016
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001017 // C99 6.2.5p11.
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00001018 FloatComplexTy = getComplexType(FloatTy);
1019 DoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(DoubleTy);
1020 LongDoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(LongDoubleTy);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001021
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001022 // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001023 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId);
1024 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass);
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001025 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001026
1027 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
1028 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1d);
1029 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray);
1030 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dBufferTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer);
1031 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2d);
1032 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray);
1033 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage3dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage3d);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001034
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001035 InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001036 InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001037 }
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001038
1039 // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no
Fariborz Jahanian29898f42012-04-16 21:03:30 +00001040 ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ?
1041 SignedCharTy : BoolTy);
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001042
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00001043 ObjCConstantStringType = QualType();
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00001044
1045 ObjCSuperType = QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001046
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00001047 // void * type
1048 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001049
1050 // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7)
1051 InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy, BuiltinType::NullPtr);
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001052
1053 // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16
1054 InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00001055
1056 // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list.
1057 VaListTagTy = QualType();
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001058}
1059
David Blaikie9c902b52011-09-25 23:23:43 +00001060DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisca0d0cd2010-09-22 14:32:24 +00001061 return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics();
1062}
1063
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +00001064AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1065 AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D];
1066 if (!Result) {
1067 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec));
1068 Result = new (Mem) AttrVec;
1069 }
1070
1071 return *Result;
1072}
1073
1074/// \brief Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration.
1075void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1076 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D);
1077 if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) {
1078 Pos->second->~AttrVec();
1079 DeclAttrs.erase(Pos);
1080 }
1081}
1082
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001083// FIXME: Remove ?
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001084MemberSpecializationInfo *
Douglas Gregor3c74d412009-10-14 20:14:33 +00001085ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001086 assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001087 return getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Var)
1088 .dyn_cast<MemberSpecializationInfo *>();
1089}
1090
1091ASTContext::TemplateOrSpecializationInfo
1092ASTContext::getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl *Var) {
1093 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, TemplateOrSpecializationInfo>::iterator Pos =
1094 TemplateOrInstantiation.find(Var);
1095 if (Pos == TemplateOrInstantiation.end())
1096 return TemplateOrSpecializationInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001097
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001098 return Pos->second;
1099}
1100
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001101void
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001102ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscdb8b3f2010-07-04 21:44:00 +00001103 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
1104 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001105 assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1106 assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001107 setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Inst, new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo(
1108 Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation));
1109}
1110
1111void
1112ASTContext::setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl *Inst,
1113 TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI) {
1114 assert(!TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] &&
1115 "Already noted what the variable was instantiated from");
1116 TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] = TSI;
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001117}
1118
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001119FunctionDecl *ASTContext::getClassScopeSpecializationPattern(
1120 const FunctionDecl *FD){
1121 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1122 llvm::DenseMap<const FunctionDecl*, FunctionDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001123 = ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.find(FD);
1124 if (Pos == ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001125 return nullptr;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001126
1127 return Pos->second;
1128}
1129
1130void ASTContext::setClassScopeSpecializationPattern(FunctionDecl *FD,
1131 FunctionDecl *Pattern) {
1132 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1133 assert(Pattern && "Class scope specialization pattern is 0");
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001134 ClassScopeSpecializationPattern[FD] = Pattern;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001135}
1136
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001137NamedDecl *
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001138ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *UUD) {
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001139 llvm::DenseMap<UsingDecl *, NamedDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001140 = InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.find(UUD);
1141 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001142 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001143
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001144 return Pos->second;
1145}
1146
1147void
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001148ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) {
1149 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) ||
1150 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) ||
1151 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) &&
1152 "pattern decl is not a using decl");
1153 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1154 InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1155}
1156
1157UsingShadowDecl *
1158ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) {
1159 llvm::DenseMap<UsingShadowDecl*, UsingShadowDecl*>::const_iterator Pos
1160 = InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.find(Inst);
1161 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001162 return nullptr;
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001163
1164 return Pos->second;
1165}
1166
1167void
1168ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst,
1169 UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) {
1170 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1171 InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001172}
1173
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001174FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) {
1175 llvm::DenseMap<FieldDecl *, FieldDecl *>::iterator Pos
1176 = InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.find(Field);
1177 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001178 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001179
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001180 return Pos->second;
1181}
1182
1183void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst,
1184 FieldDecl *Tmpl) {
1185 assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed");
1186 assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed");
1187 assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] &&
1188 "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001189
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001190 InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl;
1191}
1192
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001193ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1194ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1195 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001196 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001197 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001198 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001199
1200 return Pos->second.begin();
1201}
1202
1203ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1204ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1205 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001206 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001207 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001208 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001209
1210 return Pos->second.end();
1211}
1212
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001213unsigned
1214ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1215 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001216 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001217 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1218 return 0;
1219
1220 return Pos->second.size();
1221}
1222
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001223void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method,
1224 const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001225 assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001226 OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden);
1227}
1228
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +00001229void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods(
1230 const NamedDecl *D,
1231 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001232 assert(D);
1233
1234 if (const CXXMethodDecl *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc8e70082013-04-17 00:09:03 +00001235 Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod),
1236 overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001237 return;
1238 }
1239
1240 const ObjCMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
1241 if (!Method)
1242 return;
1243
Argyrios Kyrtzidis353f6a42012-10-09 18:19:01 +00001244 SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls;
1245 Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa7a10812012-10-09 20:08:43 +00001246 Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end());
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001247}
1248
Douglas Gregor0f2a3602011-12-03 00:30:27 +00001249void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) {
1250 assert(!Import->NextLocalImport && "Import declaration already in the chain");
1251 assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration");
1252 if (!FirstLocalImport) {
1253 FirstLocalImport = Import;
1254 LastLocalImport = Import;
1255 return;
1256 }
1257
1258 LastLocalImport->NextLocalImport = Import;
1259 LastLocalImport = Import;
1260}
1261
Chris Lattner53cfe802007-07-18 17:52:12 +00001262//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1263// Type Sizing and Analysis
1264//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001265
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001266/// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified
1267/// scalar floating point type.
1268const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001269 const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001270 assert(BT && "Not a floating point type!");
1271 switch (BT->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001272 default: llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001273 case BuiltinType::Half: return Target->getHalfFormat();
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001274 case BuiltinType::Float: return Target->getFloatFormat();
1275 case BuiltinType::Double: return Target->getDoubleFormat();
1276 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return Target->getLongDoubleFormat();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001277 }
1278}
1279
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001280CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool ForAlignof) const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001281 unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth();
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001282
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001283 bool UseAlignAttrOnly = false;
1284 if (unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment()) {
1285 Align = AlignFromAttr;
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001286
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001287 // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment
1288 // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases
1289 // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified.
1290 //
Peter Collingbourne2f3cf4b2011-09-29 18:04:28 +00001291 // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001292 // ignore that possibility; Sema should diagnose it.
1293 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) {
1294 UseAlignAttrOnly = D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1295 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1296 } else {
1297 UseAlignAttrOnly = true;
1298 }
1299 }
Fariborz Jahanian9f107182011-05-05 21:19:14 +00001300 else if (isa<FieldDecl>(D))
1301 UseAlignAttrOnly =
1302 D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1303 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001304
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001305 // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything
1306 // else about the declaration and its type.
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001307 if (UseAlignAttrOnly) {
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001308 // do nothing
1309
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001310 } else if (const ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) {
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001311 QualType T = VD->getType();
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001312 if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001313 if (ForAlignof)
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001314 T = RT->getPointeeType();
1315 else
1316 T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType());
1317 }
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001318 QualType BaseT = getBaseElementType(T);
1319 if (!BaseT->isIncompleteType() && !T->isFunctionType()) {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001320 // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the
1321 // large-array alignment on the target.
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001322 if (const ArrayType *arrayType = getAsArrayType(T)) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001323 unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth();
1324 if (!ForAlignof && MinWidth) {
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001325 if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType))
1326 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1327 else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) &&
1328 MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType)))
1329 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1330 }
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001331 }
Chad Rosier99ee7822011-07-26 07:03:04 +00001332 Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr()));
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001333 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
1334 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage())
1335 Align = std::max(Align, getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1336 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001337 }
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001338
1339 // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if
1340 // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a
1341 // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack). So calculate
1342 // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then
1343 // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type.
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001344 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
1345 const RecordDecl *Parent = Field->getParent();
1346 // We can only produce a sensible answer if the record is valid.
1347 if (!Parent->isInvalidDecl()) {
1348 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(Parent);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001349
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001350 // Start with the record's overall alignment.
1351 unsigned FieldAlign = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001352
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001353 // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record.
1354 uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex());
1355 if (Offset > 0) {
1356 // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2,
1357 // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's.
1358 uint64_t LowBitOfOffset = Offset & (~Offset + 1);
1359 if (LowBitOfOffset < FieldAlign)
1360 FieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(LowBitOfOffset);
1361 }
1362
1363 Align = std::min(Align, FieldAlign);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001364 }
Charles Davis3fc51072010-02-23 04:52:00 +00001365 }
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001366 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001367
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001368 return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align);
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001369}
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001370
John McCallf1249922012-08-21 04:10:00 +00001371// getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in
1372// chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned. This is
1373// the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type
1374// using a trivial copy/move assignment operator.
1375std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1376ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1377 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> sizeAndAlign = getTypeInfoInChars(T);
1378
1379 // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding
1380 // of a base-class subobject. We decide whether that's possible
1381 // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results.
1382 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1383 if (const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
1384 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
1385 sizeAndAlign.first = layout.getDataSize();
1386 }
1387 }
1388
1389 return sizeAndAlign;
1390}
1391
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001392/// getConstantArrayInfoInChars - Performing the computation in CharUnits
1393/// instead of in bits prevents overflowing the uint64_t for some large arrays.
1394std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1395static getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext &Context,
1396 const ConstantArrayType *CAT) {
1397 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> EltInfo =
1398 Context.getTypeInfoInChars(CAT->getElementType());
1399 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Trieuc7509072013-05-14 23:41:50 +00001400 assert((Size == 0 || static_cast<uint64_t>(EltInfo.first.getQuantity()) <=
1401 (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001402 "Overflow in array type char size evaluation");
1403 uint64_t Width = EltInfo.first.getQuantity() * Size;
1404 unsigned Align = EltInfo.second.getQuantity();
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001405 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1406 Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1407 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001408 return std::make_pair(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Width),
1409 CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align));
1410}
1411
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001412std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001413ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001414 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T))
1415 return getConstantArrayInfoInChars(*this, CAT);
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001416 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(T);
1417 return std::make_pair(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Width),
1418 toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Align));
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001419}
1420
1421std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001422ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const {
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001423 return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr());
1424}
1425
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001426bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(const Type *T) const {
1427 return getTypeInfo(T).AlignIsRequired;
1428}
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001429
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001430bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(QualType T) const {
1431 return isAlignmentRequired(T.getTypePtr());
1432}
1433
1434TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const {
Rafael Espindolae122ee12014-07-30 02:37:26 +00001435 TypeInfo TI = MemoizedTypeInfo[T];
1436 if (TI.Align)
1437 return TI;
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001438
Rafael Espindolae122ee12014-07-30 02:37:26 +00001439 // This call can invalidate TI, so we need a second lookup.
1440 TypeInfo Temp = getTypeInfoImpl(T);
1441 MemoizedTypeInfo[T] = Temp;
1442 return Temp;
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001443}
1444
1445/// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits. This
1446/// method does not work on incomplete types.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001447///
1448/// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and
1449/// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this
1450/// should take a QualType, &c.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001451TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const {
1452 uint64_t Width = 0;
1453 unsigned Align = 8;
1454 bool AlignIsRequired = false;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001455 switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001456#define TYPE(Class, Base)
1457#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001458#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001459#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
David Blaikieab277d62013-07-13 21:08:03 +00001460#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) \
1461 case Type::Class: \
1462 assert(!T->isDependentType() && "should not see dependent types here"); \
1463 return getTypeInfo(cast<Class##Type>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001464#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
John McCall15547bb2011-06-28 16:49:23 +00001465 llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001466
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001467 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
1468 case Type::FunctionProto:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001469 // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits
1470 Width = 0;
1471 Align = 32;
1472 break;
1473
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001474 case Type::IncompleteArray:
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001475 case Type::VariableArray:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001476 Width = 0;
1477 Align = getTypeAlign(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType());
1478 break;
1479
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001480 case Type::ConstantArray: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001481 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = cast<ConstantArrayType>(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001482
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001483 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(CAT->getElementType());
Abramo Bagnarad541a4c2011-12-13 11:23:52 +00001484 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001485 assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.Width <= (uint64_t)(-1) / Size) &&
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001486 "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation");
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001487 Width = EltInfo.Width * Size;
1488 Align = EltInfo.Align;
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001489 if (!getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1490 getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1491 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001492 break;
Christopher Lambc5fafa22007-12-29 05:10:55 +00001493 }
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00001494 case Type::ExtVector:
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001495 case Type::Vector: {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001496 const VectorType *VT = cast<VectorType>(T);
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001497 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType());
1498 Width = EltInfo.Width * VT->getNumElements();
Eli Friedman3df5efe2008-05-30 09:31:38 +00001499 Align = Width;
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +00001500 // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2.
1501 // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors.
Dan Gohmanef78c8e2010-04-21 23:32:43 +00001502 if (Align & (Align-1)) {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001503 Align = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Align);
1504 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
1505 }
Chad Rosiercc40ea72012-07-13 23:57:43 +00001506 // Adjust the alignment based on the target max.
1507 uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign();
1508 if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align)
1509 Align = TargetVectorAlign;
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001510 break;
1511 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001512
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001513 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001514 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001515 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!");
Chris Lattner4481b422007-07-14 01:29:45 +00001516 case BuiltinType::Void:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001517 // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits.
1518 Width = 0;
1519 Align = 8;
1520 break;
1521
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001522 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001523 Width = Target->getBoolWidth();
1524 Align = Target->getBoolAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001525 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001526 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
1527 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
1528 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001529 case BuiltinType::SChar:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001530 Width = Target->getCharWidth();
1531 Align = Target->getCharAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001532 break;
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00001533 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
1534 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001535 Width = Target->getWCharWidth();
1536 Align = Target->getWCharAlign();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001537 break;
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001538 case BuiltinType::Char16:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001539 Width = Target->getChar16Width();
1540 Align = Target->getChar16Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001541 break;
1542 case BuiltinType::Char32:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001543 Width = Target->getChar32Width();
1544 Align = Target->getChar32Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001545 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001546 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001547 case BuiltinType::Short:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001548 Width = Target->getShortWidth();
1549 Align = Target->getShortAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001550 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001551 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001552 case BuiltinType::Int:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001553 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1554 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001555 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001556 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001557 case BuiltinType::Long:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001558 Width = Target->getLongWidth();
1559 Align = Target->getLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001560 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001561 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001562 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001563 Width = Target->getLongLongWidth();
1564 Align = Target->getLongLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001565 break;
Chris Lattner0a415ec2009-04-30 02:55:13 +00001566 case BuiltinType::Int128:
1567 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
1568 Width = 128;
1569 Align = 128; // int128_t is 128-bit aligned on all targets.
1570 break;
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001571 case BuiltinType::Half:
1572 Width = Target->getHalfWidth();
1573 Align = Target->getHalfAlign();
1574 break;
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001575 case BuiltinType::Float:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001576 Width = Target->getFloatWidth();
1577 Align = Target->getFloatAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001578 break;
1579 case BuiltinType::Double:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001580 Width = Target->getDoubleWidth();
1581 Align = Target->getDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001582 break;
1583 case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001584 Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth();
1585 Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001586 break;
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001587 case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001588 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t)
1589 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); // == sizeof(void*)
Sebastian Redla81b0b72009-05-27 19:34:06 +00001590 break;
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001591 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
1592 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
1593 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001594 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1595 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001596 break;
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001597 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
1598 // Samplers are modeled as integers.
1599 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1600 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
1601 break;
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001602 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001603 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
1604 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
1605 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
1606 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
1607 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
1608 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
1609 // Currently these types are pointers to opaque types.
1610 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1611 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
1612 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001613 }
Chris Lattner48f84b82007-07-15 23:46:53 +00001614 break;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00001615 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001616 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1617 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001618 break;
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001619 case Type::BlockPointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001620 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1621 cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001622 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1623 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001624 break;
1625 }
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001626 case Type::LValueReference:
1627 case Type::RValueReference: {
1628 // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go
1629 // the pointer route.
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001630 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1631 cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001632 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1633 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001634 break;
1635 }
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001636 case Type::Pointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001637 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001638 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1639 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001640 break;
1641 }
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001642 case Type::MemberPointer: {
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00001643 const MemberPointerType *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T);
Benjamin Kramer867ea1d2014-03-02 13:01:17 +00001644 std::tie(Width, Align) = ABI->getMemberPointerWidthAndAlign(MPT);
Anders Carlsson32440a02009-05-17 02:06:04 +00001645 break;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001646 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001647 case Type::Complex: {
1648 // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the
1649 // size.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001650 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType());
1651 Width = EltInfo.Width * 2;
1652 Align = EltInfo.Align;
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001653 break;
1654 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001655 case Type::ObjCObject:
1656 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr());
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001657 case Type::Adjusted:
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00001658 case Type::Decayed:
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001659 return getTypeInfo(cast<AdjustedType>(T)->getAdjustedType().getTypePtr());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001660 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001661 const ObjCInterfaceType *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T);
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001662 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001663 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001664 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001665 break;
1666 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001667 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001668 case Type::Enum: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001669 const TagType *TT = cast<TagType>(T);
1670
1671 if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
Douglas Gregor7f971892011-04-20 17:29:44 +00001672 Width = 8;
1673 Align = 8;
Chris Lattner572100b2008-08-09 21:35:13 +00001674 break;
1675 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001676
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001677 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT))
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001678 return getTypeInfo(ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType());
1679
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001680 const RecordType *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT);
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001681 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001682 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001683 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Chris Lattner49a953a2007-07-23 22:46:22 +00001684 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001685 }
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001686
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001687 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001688 return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)->
1689 getReplacementType().getTypePtr());
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001690
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001691 case Type::Auto: {
1692 const AutoType *A = cast<AutoType>(T);
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00001693 assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() &&
1694 "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type");
Matt Beaumont-Gay7a24210e2011-02-22 20:00:16 +00001695 return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr());
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001696 }
1697
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00001698 case Type::Paren:
1699 return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr());
1700
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001701 case Type::Typedef: {
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00001702 const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = cast<TypedefType>(T)->getDecl();
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001703 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(Typedef->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001704 // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed
1705 // alignment we have. This violates the GCC documentation (which says that
1706 // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001707 if (unsigned AttrAlign = Typedef->getMaxAlignment()) {
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001708 Align = AttrAlign;
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001709 AlignIsRequired = true;
1710 } else
1711 Align = Info.Align;
1712 Width = Info.Width;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001713 break;
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001714 }
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001715
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00001716 case Type::Elaborated:
1717 return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001718
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00001719 case Type::Attributed:
1720 return getTypeInfo(
1721 cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr());
1722
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001723 case Type::Atomic: {
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001724 // Start with the base type information.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001725 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType());
1726 Width = Info.Width;
1727 Align = Info.Align;
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001728
1729 // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max
1730 // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more
1731 // favorable to atomic operations:
1732 if (Width != 0 && Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) {
1733 // Round the size up to a power of 2.
1734 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width))
1735 Width = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Width);
1736
1737 // Set the alignment equal to the size.
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001738 Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width);
1739 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001740 }
1741
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001742 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001743
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001744 assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2");
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001745 return TypeInfo(Width, Align, AlignIsRequired);
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001746}
1747
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001748/// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters.
1749CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const {
1750 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth());
1751}
1752
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001753/// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters.
1754int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const {
1755 return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth();
1756}
1757
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001758/// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters.
1759/// This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001760CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001761 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001762}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001763CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001764 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001765}
1766
Ken Dycka6046ab2010-01-26 17:25:18 +00001767/// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001768/// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001769CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001770 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001771}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001772CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001773 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001774}
1775
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001776/// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified
1777/// type for the current target in bits. This can be different than the ABI
1778/// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance to overalign
1779/// a data type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001780unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const {
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001781 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfo(T);
1782 unsigned ABIAlign = TI.Align;
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001783
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +00001784 if (Target->getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::xcore)
1785 return ABIAlign; // Never overalign on XCore.
1786
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001787 // Double and long long should be naturally aligned if possible.
Richard Smithd7e1fe42014-06-10 23:43:44 +00001788 T = T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
David Majnemer1d4db8f2014-02-24 23:43:27 +00001789 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001790 T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr();
1791 if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) ||
Chad Rosierb57321a2012-03-21 20:20:47 +00001792 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
1793 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong))
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00001794 // Don't increase the alignment if an alignment attribute was specified on a
1795 // typedef declaration.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001796 if (!TI.AlignIsRequired)
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00001797 return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T));
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001798
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001799 return ABIAlign;
1800}
1801
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001802/// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given
1803/// to a global variable of the specified type.
1804unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const {
1805 return std::max(getTypeAlign(T), getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1806}
1807
1808/// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that
1809/// should be given to a global variable of the specified type.
1810CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const {
1811 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T));
1812}
1813
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001814/// DeepCollectObjCIvars -
1815/// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in
1816/// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for
1817/// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class
1818/// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known.
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001819///
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001820void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI,
1821 bool leafClass,
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001822 SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const {
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001823 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass())
1824 DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars);
1825 if (!leafClass) {
Aaron Ballman59abbd42014-03-13 21:09:43 +00001826 for (const auto *I : OI->ivars())
1827 Ivars.push_back(I);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00001828 } else {
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001829 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI);
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001830 for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv;
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001831 Iv= Iv->getNextIvar())
1832 Ivars.push_back(Iv);
1833 }
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001834}
1835
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001836/// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and
1837/// those inherited by it.
1838void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl,
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00001839 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001840 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) {
Ted Kremenek0ef508d2010-09-01 01:21:15 +00001841 // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of
1842 // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories.
Aaron Ballmana9f49e32014-03-13 20:55:22 +00001843 for (auto *Proto : OI->all_referenced_protocols()) {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001844 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00001845 for (auto *P : Proto->protocols()) {
1846 Protocols.insert(P->getCanonicalDecl());
1847 CollectInheritedProtocols(P, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001848 }
Fariborz Jahanian8e3b9db2010-02-25 18:24:33 +00001849 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001850
1851 // Categories of this Interface.
Aaron Ballman3fe486a2014-03-13 21:23:55 +00001852 for (const auto *Cat : OI->visible_categories())
1853 CollectInheritedProtocols(Cat, Protocols);
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001854
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001855 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass())
1856 while (SD) {
1857 CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols);
1858 SD = SD->getSuperClass();
1859 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001860 } else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) {
Aaron Ballman19a41762014-03-14 12:55:57 +00001861 for (auto *Proto : OC->protocols()) {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001862 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00001863 for (const auto *P : Proto->protocols())
1864 CollectInheritedProtocols(P, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001865 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001866 } else if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) {
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00001867 for (auto *Proto : OP->protocols()) {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001868 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00001869 for (const auto *P : Proto->protocols())
1870 CollectInheritedProtocols(P, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001871 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001872 }
1873}
1874
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001875unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const {
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00001876 unsigned count = 0;
1877 // Count ivars declared in class extension.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +00001878 for (const auto *Ext : OI->known_extensions())
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001879 count += Ext->ivar_size();
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001880
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00001881 // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation. This
1882 // includes synthesized ivars.
1883 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation())
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001884 count += ImplDecl->ivar_size();
1885
Fariborz Jahanian7c809592009-06-04 01:19:09 +00001886 return count;
1887}
1888
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2e809ce2012-02-03 05:58:16 +00001889bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) {
1890 if (!E)
1891 return false;
1892
1893 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
1894 if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true;
1895
1896 if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
1897 E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this,
1898 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
1899 return true;
1900
1901 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
1902 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true;
1903
1904 return false;
1905}
1906
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00001907/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl,or NULL if none exists.
1908ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) {
1909 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
1910 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
1911 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
1912 return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001913 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00001914}
1915/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or NULL if none exists.
1916ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) {
1917 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
1918 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
1919 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
1920 return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001921 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00001922}
1923
1924/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl.
1925void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD,
1926 ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) {
1927 assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
1928 ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD;
1929}
1930/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl.
1931void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD,
1932 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) {
1933 assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
1934 ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD;
1935}
1936
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001937const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface(
1938 const NamedDecl *ND) const {
1939 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID =
1940 dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001941 return ID;
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001942 if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD =
1943 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001944 return CD->getClassInterface();
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001945 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD =
1946 dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001947 return IMD->getClassInterface();
1948
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001949 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001950}
1951
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001952/// \brief Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl,or NULL if
1953/// none exists.
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00001954Expr *ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInits(const VarDecl*VD) {
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001955 assert(VD && "Passed null params");
1956 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
1957 "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00001958 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl*, Expr*>::iterator
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001959 I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001960 return (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end()) ? cast<Expr>(I->second) : nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001961}
1962
1963/// \brief Set the copy inialization expression of a block var decl.
1964void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInits(VarDecl*VD, Expr* Init) {
1965 assert(VD && Init && "Passed null params");
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001966 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
1967 "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001968 BlockVarCopyInits[VD] = Init;
1969}
1970
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001971TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001972 unsigned DataSize) const {
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00001973 if (!DataSize)
1974 DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T);
1975 else
1976 assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) &&
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001977 "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!");
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00001978
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001979 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo =
1980 (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8);
1981 new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T);
1982 return TInfo;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis3f79ad72009-08-19 01:27:32 +00001983}
1984
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001985TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +00001986 SourceLocation L) const {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001987 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T);
Douglas Gregor2d525f02011-01-25 19:13:18 +00001988 DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L);
John McCall3665e002009-10-23 21:14:09 +00001989 return DI;
1990}
1991
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001992const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001993ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001994 return getObjCLayout(D, nullptr);
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001995}
1996
1997const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001998ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout(
1999 const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const {
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002000 return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D);
2001}
2002
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002003//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2004// Type creation/memoization methods
2005//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2006
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002007QualType
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002008ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const {
2009 unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers();
2010 quals.removeFastQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002011
2012 // Check if we've already instantiated this type.
2013 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002014 ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002015 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002016 if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) {
2017 assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals);
2018 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002019 }
2020
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002021 // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type.
2022 QualType canon;
2023 if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
2024 SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002025 canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals);
2026 canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002027
2028 // Re-find the insert position.
2029 (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2030 }
2031
2032 ExtQuals *eq = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals);
2033 ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos);
2034 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002035}
2036
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002037QualType
2038ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T, unsigned AddressSpace) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002039 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
2040 if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace)
Chris Lattner445fcab2008-02-20 20:55:12 +00002041 return T;
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002042
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002043 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2044 // into one ExtQuals node.
2045 QualifierCollector Quals;
2046 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002047
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002048 // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get
2049 // another one.
2050 assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() &&
2051 "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!");
2052 Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002053
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002054 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Christopher Lamb025b5fb2008-02-04 02:31:56 +00002055}
2056
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002057QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002058 Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const {
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002059 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002060 if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr)
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002061 return T;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002062
John McCall53fa7142010-12-24 02:08:15 +00002063 if (const PointerType *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2064 QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00002065 if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb68215c2009-06-03 17:15:17 +00002066 QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr);
2067 return getPointerType(ResultType);
2068 }
2069 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002070
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002071 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2072 // into one ExtQuals node.
2073 QualifierCollector Quals;
2074 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002075
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002076 // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get
2077 // another one.
2078 assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() &&
2079 "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!");
2080 Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002081
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002082 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002083}
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002084
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002085const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T,
2086 FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) {
2087 if (T->getExtInfo() == Info)
2088 return T;
2089
2090 QualType Result;
2091 if (const FunctionNoProtoType *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002092 Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getReturnType(), Info);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002093 } else {
2094 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T);
2095 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2096 EPI.ExtInfo = Info;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002097 Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002098 }
2099
2100 return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr());
2101}
2102
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002103void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD,
2104 QualType ResultType) {
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002105 FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
2106 while (true) {
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002107 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2108 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002109 FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI));
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002110 if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl())
2111 FD = Next;
2112 else
2113 break;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002114 }
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002115 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener())
2116 L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002117}
2118
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002119/// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex
2120/// number with the specified element type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002121QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002122 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2123 // structure.
2124 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2125 ComplexType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002126
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002127 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002128 if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2129 return QualType(CT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002130
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002131 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2132 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2133 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002134 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002135 Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002136
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002137 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2138 ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002139 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002140 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002141 ComplexType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ComplexType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002142 Types.push_back(New);
2143 ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2144 return QualType(New, 0);
2145}
2146
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00002147/// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to
2148/// the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002149QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +00002150 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2151 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002152 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002153 PointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002154
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002155 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002156 if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002157 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002158
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002159 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2160 // so fill in the canonical type field.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002161 QualType Canonical;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002162 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002163 Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002164
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002165 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2166 PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002167 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002168 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002169 PointerType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PointerType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002170 Types.push_back(New);
2171 PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002172 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00002173}
2174
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002175QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedType(QualType Orig, QualType New) const {
2176 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2177 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, Orig, New);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002178 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002179 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2180 if (AT)
2181 return QualType(AT, 0);
2182
2183 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(New);
2184
2185 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2186 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002187 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002188
2189 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2190 AdjustedType(Type::Adjusted, Orig, New, Canonical);
2191 Types.push_back(AT);
2192 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2193 return QualType(AT, 0);
2194}
2195
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002196QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType T) const {
2197 assert((T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && "T does not decay");
2198
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002199 QualType Decayed;
2200
2201 // C99 6.7.5.3p7:
2202 // A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be
2203 // adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type
2204 // qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of
2205 // the array type derivation.
2206 if (T->isArrayType())
2207 Decayed = getArrayDecayedType(T);
2208
2209 // C99 6.7.5.3p8:
2210 // A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type"
2211 // shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as
2212 // in 6.3.2.1.
2213 if (T->isFunctionType())
2214 Decayed = getPointerType(T);
2215
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002216 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2217 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, T, Decayed);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002218 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002219 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2220 if (AT)
2221 return QualType(AT, 0);
2222
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002223 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decayed);
2224
2225 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002226 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002227 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002228
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002229 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecayedType(T, Decayed, Canonical);
2230 Types.push_back(AT);
2231 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2232 return QualType(AT, 0);
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002233}
2234
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002235/// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002236/// a pointer to the specified block.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002237QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const {
Steve Naroff0ac012832008-08-28 19:20:44 +00002238 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only");
2239 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002240 // structure.
2241 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2242 BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002243
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002244 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002245 if (BlockPointerType *PT =
2246 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2247 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002248
2249 // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002250 // type either so fill in the canonical type field.
2251 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002252 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002253 Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002254
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002255 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2256 BlockPointerType *NewIP =
2257 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002258 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002259 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002260 BlockPointerType *New
2261 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical);
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002262 Types.push_back(New);
2263 BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2264 return QualType(New, 0);
2265}
2266
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002267/// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2268/// lvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002269QualType
2270ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const {
Douglas Gregor291e8ee2011-05-21 22:16:50 +00002271 assert(getCanonicalType(T) != OverloadTy &&
2272 "Unresolved overloaded function type");
2273
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002274 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2275 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002276 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002277 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002278
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002279 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002280 if (LValueReferenceType *RT =
2281 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002282 return QualType(RT, 0);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002283
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002284 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2285
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002286 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2287 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2288 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002289 if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2290 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2291 Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002292
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002293 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002294 LValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2295 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002296 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002297 }
2298
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002299 LValueReferenceType *New
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002300 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical,
2301 SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002302 Types.push_back(New);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002303 LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002304
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002305 return QualType(New, 0);
2306}
2307
2308/// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2309/// rvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002310QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const {
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002311 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2312 // structure.
2313 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002314 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002315
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002316 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002317 if (RValueReferenceType *RT =
2318 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2319 return QualType(RT, 0);
2320
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002321 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2322
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002323 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2324 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2325 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002326 if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2327 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2328 Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002329
2330 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2331 RValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2332 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002333 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002334 }
2335
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002336 RValueReferenceType *New
2337 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002338 Types.push_back(New);
2339 RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002340 return QualType(New, 0);
2341}
2342
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002343/// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a
2344/// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002345QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002346 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2347 // structure.
2348 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2349 MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls);
2350
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002351 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002352 if (MemberPointerType *PT =
2353 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2354 return QualType(PT, 0);
2355
2356 // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
2357 // type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2358 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor615ac672009-11-04 16:49:01 +00002359 if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002360 Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls));
2361
2362 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2363 MemberPointerType *NewIP =
2364 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002365 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002366 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002367 MemberPointerType *New
2368 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002369 Types.push_back(New);
2370 MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2371 return QualType(New, 0);
2372}
2373
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002374/// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002375/// array of the specified element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002376QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002377 const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002378 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002379 unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const {
Sebastian Redl2dfdb822009-11-05 15:52:31 +00002380 assert((EltTy->isDependentType() ||
2381 EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) &&
Eli Friedmanbe7e42b2009-05-29 20:17:55 +00002382 "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!");
2383
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002384 // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for
2385 // the target.
2386 llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn);
Jay Foad6d4db0c2010-12-07 08:25:34 +00002387 ArySize =
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00002388 ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getPointerWidth(getTargetAddressSpace(EltTy)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002389
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002390 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002391 ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, EltTy, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002392
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002393 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002394 if (ConstantArrayType *ATP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002395 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002396 return QualType(ATP, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002397
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002398 // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, this won't
2399 // be a canonical type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2400 QualType Canon;
2401 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2402 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002403 Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002404 ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002405 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002406
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002407 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002408 ConstantArrayType *NewIP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002409 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002410 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002411 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002412
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002413 ConstantArrayType *New = new(*this,TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002414 ConstantArrayType(EltTy, Canon, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002415 ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002416 Types.push_back(New);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002417 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002418}
2419
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002420/// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be
2421/// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known
2422/// sizes replaced with [*].
2423QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const {
2424 // Vastly most common case.
2425 if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002426
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002427 QualType result;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002428
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002429 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002430 const Type *ty = split.Ty;
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002431 switch (ty->getTypeClass()) {
2432#define TYPE(Class, Base)
2433#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
2434#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
2435#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
2436 llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?");
2437
2438 // These types should never be variably-modified.
2439 case Type::Builtin:
2440 case Type::Complex:
2441 case Type::Vector:
2442 case Type::ExtVector:
2443 case Type::DependentSizedExtVector:
2444 case Type::ObjCObject:
2445 case Type::ObjCInterface:
2446 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
2447 case Type::Record:
2448 case Type::Enum:
2449 case Type::UnresolvedUsing:
2450 case Type::TypeOfExpr:
2451 case Type::TypeOf:
2452 case Type::Decltype:
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00002453 case Type::UnaryTransform:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002454 case Type::DependentName:
2455 case Type::InjectedClassName:
2456 case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
2457 case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization:
2458 case Type::TemplateTypeParm:
2459 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack:
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00002460 case Type::Auto:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002461 case Type::PackExpansion:
2462 llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified");
2463
2464 // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to
2465 // further decay.
2466 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
2467 case Type::FunctionProto:
2468 case Type::BlockPointer:
2469 case Type::MemberPointer:
2470 return type;
2471
2472 // These types can be variably-modified. All these modifications
2473 // preserve structure except as noted by comments.
2474 // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op
2475 // optimizations available here.
2476 case Type::Pointer:
2477 result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(
2478 cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType()));
2479 break;
2480
2481 case Type::LValueReference: {
2482 const LValueReferenceType *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty);
2483 result = getLValueReferenceType(
2484 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()),
2485 lv->isSpelledAsLValue());
2486 break;
2487 }
2488
2489 case Type::RValueReference: {
2490 const RValueReferenceType *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty);
2491 result = getRValueReferenceType(
2492 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()));
2493 break;
2494 }
2495
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00002496 case Type::Atomic: {
2497 const AtomicType *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty);
2498 result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType()));
2499 break;
2500 }
2501
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002502 case Type::ConstantArray: {
2503 const ConstantArrayType *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty);
2504 result = getConstantArrayType(
2505 getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()),
2506 cat->getSize(),
2507 cat->getSizeModifier(),
2508 cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
2509 break;
2510 }
2511
2512 case Type::DependentSizedArray: {
2513 const DependentSizedArrayType *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty);
2514 result = getDependentSizedArrayType(
2515 getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()),
2516 dat->getSizeExpr(),
2517 dat->getSizeModifier(),
2518 dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2519 dat->getBracketsRange());
2520 break;
2521 }
2522
2523 // Turn incomplete types into [*] types.
2524 case Type::IncompleteArray: {
2525 const IncompleteArrayType *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty);
2526 result = getVariableArrayType(
2527 getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002528 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002529 ArrayType::Normal,
2530 iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2531 SourceRange());
2532 break;
2533 }
2534
2535 // Turn VLA types into [*] types.
2536 case Type::VariableArray: {
2537 const VariableArrayType *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty);
2538 result = getVariableArrayType(
2539 getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002540 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002541 ArrayType::Star,
2542 vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2543 vat->getBracketsRange());
2544 break;
2545 }
2546 }
2547
2548 // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002549 return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals);
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002550}
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002551
Steve Naroffcadebd02007-08-30 18:14:25 +00002552/// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a
2553/// variable array of the specified element type.
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00002554QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy,
2555 Expr *NumElts,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002556 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002557 unsigned IndexTypeQuals,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002558 SourceRange Brackets) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002559 // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's
2560 // that have an expression provided for their size.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002561 QualType Canon;
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002562
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002563 // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type.
2564 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2565 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002566 Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002567 IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002568 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002569 }
2570
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002571 VariableArrayType *New = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002572 VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002573
2574 VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New);
2575 Types.push_back(New);
2576 return QualType(New, 0);
2577}
2578
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002579/// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to
2580/// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element
Douglas Gregorf3f95522009-07-31 00:23:35 +00002581/// type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002582QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,
2583 Expr *numElements,
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002584 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002585 unsigned elementTypeQuals,
2586 SourceRange brackets) const {
2587 assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() ||
2588 numElements->isValueDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002589 "Size must be type- or value-dependent!");
2590
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002591 // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number
2592 // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent
2593 // initializer. We do no canonicalization here at all, which is okay
2594 // because they can't be used in most locations.
2595 if (!numElements) {
2596 DependentSizedArrayType *newType
2597 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2598 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, QualType(),
2599 numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2600 brackets);
2601 Types.push_back(newType);
2602 return QualType(newType, 0);
2603 }
2604
2605 // Otherwise, we actually build a new type every time, but we
2606 // also build a canonical type.
2607
2608 SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
2609
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002610 void *insertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002611 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002612 DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(ID, *this,
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002613 QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002614 ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002615
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002616 // Look for an existing type with these properties.
2617 DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy =
2618 DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002619
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002620 // If we don't have one, build one.
2621 if (!canonTy) {
2622 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002623 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002624 QualType(), numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2625 brackets);
2626 DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
2627 Types.push_back(canonTy);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002628 }
2629
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002630 // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array.
2631 QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0),
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002632 canonElementType.Quals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002633
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002634 // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type,
2635 // then just use that as our result.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002636 if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType)
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002637 return canon;
2638
2639 // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling
2640 // of the element type.
2641 DependentSizedArrayType *sugaredType
2642 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2643 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, canon, numElements,
2644 ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets);
2645 Types.push_back(sugaredType);
2646 return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002647}
2648
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002649QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002650 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002651 unsigned elementTypeQuals) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002652 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002653 IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002654
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002655 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002656 if (IncompleteArrayType *iat =
2657 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos))
2658 return QualType(iat, 0);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002659
2660 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002661 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. We also have to pull
2662 // qualifiers off the element type.
2663 QualType canon;
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002664
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002665 if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2666 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002667 canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002668 ASM, elementTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002669 canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002670
2671 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002672 IncompleteArrayType *existing =
2673 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2674 assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing;
Ted Kremenek843ebedd2007-10-29 23:37:31 +00002675 }
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002676
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002677 IncompleteArrayType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2678 IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002679
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002680 IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos);
2681 Types.push_back(newType);
2682 return QualType(newType, 0);
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002683}
2684
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002685/// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of
2686/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
John Thompson22334602010-02-05 00:12:22 +00002687QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002688 VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002689 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002690
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002691 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2692 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002693 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind);
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002694
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002695 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002696 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2697 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2698
2699 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2700 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2701 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00002702 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Bob Wilson77954802010-11-16 00:32:20 +00002703 Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002704
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002705 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2706 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002707 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002708 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002709 VectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002710 VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind);
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002711 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2712 Types.push_back(New);
2713 return QualType(New, 0);
2714}
2715
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002716/// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002717/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002718QualType
2719ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts) const {
Douglas Gregor39c02722011-06-15 16:02:29 +00002720 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002721
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002722 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2723 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002724 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002725 VectorType::GenericVector);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002726 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002727 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2728 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2729
2730 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2731 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2732 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002733 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002734 Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002735
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002736 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2737 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002738 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002739 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002740 ExtVectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2741 ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical);
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002742 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2743 Types.push_back(New);
2744 return QualType(New, 0);
2745}
2746
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002747QualType
2748ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,
2749 Expr *SizeExpr,
2750 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002751 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002752 DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType),
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002753 SizeExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002754
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002755 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002756 DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon
2757 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2758 DependentSizedExtVectorType *New;
2759 if (Canon) {
2760 // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as
2761 // the canonical type for a newly-built type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002762 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2763 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(Canon, 0),
2764 SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002765 } else {
2766 QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType);
2767 if (CanonVecTy == vecType) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002768 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2769 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr,
2770 AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002771
2772 DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck
2773 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2774 assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken");
2775 (void)CanonCheck;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002776 DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2777 } else {
2778 QualType Canon = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
2779 SourceLocation());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002780 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2781 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, Canon, SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002782 }
2783 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002784
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00002785 Types.push_back(New);
2786 return QualType(New, 0);
2787}
2788
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002789/// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'.
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002790///
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002791QualType
2792ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,
2793 const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const {
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002794 const CallingConv CallConv = Info.getCC();
2795
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002796 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2797 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002798 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00002799 FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002800
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002801 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002802 if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002803 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002804 return QualType(FT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002805
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002806 QualType Canonical;
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002807 if (!ResultTy.isCanonical()) {
2808 Canonical = getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalType(ResultTy), Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002809
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002810 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002811 FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP =
2812 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002813 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002814 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002815
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002816 FunctionProtoType::ExtInfo newInfo = Info.withCallingConv(CallConv);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002817 FunctionNoProtoType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002818 FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, newInfo);
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002819 Types.push_back(New);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002820 FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002821 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002822}
2823
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002824/// \brief Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function.
2825static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) {
2826 return T.isCanonical() &&
2827 (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None ||
2828 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone);
2829}
2830
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002831QualType
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002832ASTContext::getFunctionType(QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002833 const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI) const {
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002834 size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size();
2835
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002836 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2837 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002838 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002839 FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI,
2840 *this);
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00002841
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002842 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002843 if (FunctionProtoType *FTP =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002844 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002845 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002846
2847 // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not.
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002848 bool isCanonical =
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002849 EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_None && isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) &&
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002850 !EPI.HasTrailingReturn;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002851 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002852 if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam())
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002853 isCanonical = false;
2854
2855 // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it.
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002856 // The exception spec is not part of the canonical type.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002857 QualType Canonical;
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002858 if (!isCanonical) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00002859 SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002860 CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
2861 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002862 CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i]));
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002863
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002864 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI;
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002865 CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
Sebastian Redl7c6c9e92011-03-06 10:52:04 +00002866 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpecType = EST_None;
2867 CanonicalEPI.NumExceptions = 0;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002868
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002869 // Result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers.
2870 QualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalType(ResultTy);
2871 if (ResultTy.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) {
2872 Qualifiers Qs = CanResultTy.getQualifiers();
2873 Qs.removeObjCLifetime();
2874 CanResultTy = getQualifiedType(CanResultTy.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2875 }
2876
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002877 Canonical = getFunctionType(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002878
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00002879 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002880 FunctionProtoType *NewIP =
2881 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002882 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002883 }
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002884
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002885 // FunctionProtoType objects are allocated with extra bytes after
2886 // them for three variable size arrays at the end:
2887 // - parameter types
2888 // - exception types
2889 // - consumed-arguments flags
2890 // Instead of the exception types, there could be a noexcept
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002891 // expression, or information used to resolve the exception
2892 // specification.
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002893 size_t Size = sizeof(FunctionProtoType) +
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002894 NumArgs * sizeof(QualType);
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002895 if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_Dynamic) {
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002896 Size += EPI.NumExceptions * sizeof(QualType);
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002897 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_ComputedNoexcept) {
Sebastian Redl31ad7542011-03-13 17:09:40 +00002898 Size += sizeof(Expr*);
Richard Smithf623c962012-04-17 00:58:00 +00002899 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_Uninstantiated) {
Richard Smithd3729422012-04-19 00:08:28 +00002900 Size += 2 * sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002901 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_Unevaluated) {
2902 Size += sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002903 }
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00002904 if (EPI.ConsumedParameters)
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002905 Size += NumArgs * sizeof(bool);
2906
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002907 FunctionProtoType *FTP = (FunctionProtoType*) Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002908 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002909 new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002910 Types.push_back(FTP);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002911 FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002912 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002913}
Chris Lattneref51c202006-11-10 07:17:23 +00002914
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002915#ifndef NDEBUG
2916static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) {
2917 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false;
2918 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
2919 if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD))
2920 return true;
2921 if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() &&
2922 !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD))
2923 return true;
2924 return false;
2925}
2926#endif
2927
2928/// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the
2929/// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration.
2930QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002931 QualType TST) const {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002932 assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl));
2933 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) {
2934 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00002935 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002936 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type");
2937 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
2938 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
2939 } else {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002940 Type *newType =
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00002941 new (*this, TypeAlignment) InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002942 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2943 Types.push_back(newType);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002944 }
2945 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2946}
2947
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00002948/// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
2949/// specified type declaration.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002950QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis89656d22008-10-16 16:50:47 +00002951 assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002952 assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002953
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002954 if (const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl))
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00002955 return getTypedefType(Typedef);
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002956
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002957 assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) &&
2958 "Template type parameter types are always available.");
2959
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00002960 if (const RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00002961 assert(Record->isFirstDecl() && "struct/union has previous declaration");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002962 assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002963 return getRecordType(Record);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00002964 } else if (const EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00002965 assert(Enum->isFirstDecl() && "enum has previous declaration");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002966 return getEnumType(Enum);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00002967 } else if (const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Using =
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00002968 dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002969 Type *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnresolvedUsingType(Using);
2970 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2971 Types.push_back(newType);
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00002972 } else
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002973 llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00002974
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00002975 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00002976}
2977
Chris Lattner32d920b2007-01-26 02:01:53 +00002978/// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002979/// specified typedef name decl.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00002980QualType
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002981ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
2982 QualType Canonical) const {
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002983 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002984
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00002985 if (Canonical.isNull())
2986 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002987 TypedefType *newType = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002988 TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Canonical);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002989 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2990 Types.push_back(newType);
2991 return QualType(newType, 0);
Chris Lattnerd0342e52006-11-20 04:02:15 +00002992}
2993
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002994QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002995 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2996
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00002997 if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002998 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
2999 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3000
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003001 RecordType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RecordType(Decl);
3002 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3003 Types.push_back(newType);
3004 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003005}
3006
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003007QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003008 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3009
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003010 if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003011 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3012 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3013
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003014 EnumType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) EnumType(Decl);
3015 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3016 Types.push_back(newType);
3017 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003018}
3019
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003020QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(AttributedType::Kind attrKind,
3021 QualType modifiedType,
3022 QualType equivalentType) {
3023 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id;
3024 AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3025
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003026 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003027 AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos);
3028 if (type) return QualType(type, 0);
3029
3030 QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType);
3031 type = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3032 AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3033
3034 Types.push_back(type);
3035 AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos);
3036
3037 return QualType(type, 0);
3038}
3039
3040
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003041/// \brief Retrieve a substitution-result type.
3042QualType
3043ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003044 QualType Replacement) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00003045 assert(Replacement.isCanonical()
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003046 && "replacement types must always be canonical");
3047
3048 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3049 SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Parm, Replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003050 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003051 SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm
3052 = SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3053
3054 if (!SubstParm) {
3055 SubstParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3056 SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Parm, Replacement);
3057 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3058 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3059 }
3060
3061 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3062}
3063
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003064/// \brief Retrieve a
3065QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(
3066 const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
3067 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) {
3068#ifndef NDEBUG
Aaron Ballman2a89e852014-07-15 21:32:31 +00003069 for (const auto &P : ArgPack.pack_elements()) {
3070 assert(P.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&"Pack contains a non-type");
3071 assert(P.getAsType().isCanonical() && "Pack contains non-canonical type");
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003072 }
3073#endif
3074
3075 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3076 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, Parm, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003077 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003078 if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3079 = SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3080 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3081
3082 QualType Canon;
3083 if (!Parm->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
3084 Canon = getCanonicalType(QualType(Parm, 0));
3085 Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Canon),
3086 ArgPack);
3087 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3088 }
3089
3090 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3091 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Parm, Canon,
3092 ArgPack);
3093 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3094 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3095 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3096}
3097
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003098/// \brief Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003099/// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally)
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003100/// name.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003101QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index,
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003102 bool ParameterPack,
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003103 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const {
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003104 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003105 TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003106 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003107 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003108 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3109
3110 if (TypeParm)
3111 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003112
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003113 if (TTPDecl) {
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003114 QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003115 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003116
3117 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck
3118 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3119 assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken");
3120 (void)TypeCheck;
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003121 } else
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003122 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3123 TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003124
3125 Types.push_back(TypeParm);
3126 TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos);
3127
3128 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
3129}
3130
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003131TypeSourceInfo *
3132ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,
3133 SourceLocation NameLoc,
3134 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003135 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003136 assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3137 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003138 QualType TST = getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args, Underlying);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003139
3140 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST);
David Blaikie6adc78e2013-02-18 22:06:02 +00003141 TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL =
3142 DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>();
Abramo Bagnara48c05be2012-02-06 14:41:24 +00003143 TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003144 TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc);
3145 TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc());
3146 TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc());
3147 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i)
3148 TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo());
3149 return DI;
3150}
3151
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003152QualType
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003153ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003154 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003155 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003156 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3157 "No dependent template names here!");
3158
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003159 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
3160
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003161 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec;
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003162 ArgVec.reserve(NumArgs);
3163 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
3164 ArgVec.push_back(Args[i].getArgument());
3165
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00003166 return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec.data(), NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003167 Underlying);
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003168}
3169
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003170#ifndef NDEBUG
3171static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(const TemplateArgument *Args,
3172 unsigned NumArgs) {
3173 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3174 if (Args[I].isPackExpansion())
3175 return true;
3176
3177 return true;
3178}
3179#endif
3180
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003181QualType
3182ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003183 const TemplateArgument *Args,
3184 unsigned NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003185 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003186 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3187 "No dependent template names here!");
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003188 // Look through qualified template names.
3189 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3190 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003191
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003192 bool IsTypeAlias =
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003193 Template.getAsTemplateDecl() &&
3194 isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Template.getAsTemplateDecl());
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003195 QualType CanonType;
3196 if (!Underlying.isNull())
3197 CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying);
3198 else {
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003199 // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains
3200 // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack.
3201 assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args, NumArgs)) &&
3202 "Caller must compute aliased type");
3203 IsTypeAlias = false;
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003204 CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args,
3205 NumArgs);
3206 }
Douglas Gregord56a91e2009-02-26 22:19:44 +00003207
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003208 // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't
3209 // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that
3210 // we don't unique and don't want to lose.
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003211 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3212 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs +
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003213 (IsTypeAlias? sizeof(QualType) : 0),
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003214 TypeAlignment);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003215 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003216 = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, NumArgs, CanonType,
3217 IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003218
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003219 Types.push_back(Spec);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003220 return QualType(Spec, 0);
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003221}
3222
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003223QualType
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003224ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
3225 const TemplateArgument *Args,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003226 unsigned NumArgs) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003227 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3228 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003229
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003230 // Look through qualified template names.
3231 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3232 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003233
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003234 // Build the canonical template specialization type.
3235 TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template);
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003236 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> CanonArgs;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003237 CanonArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
3238 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3239 CanonArgs.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]));
3240
3241 // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already
3242 // exists.
3243 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3244 TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate,
3245 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs, *this);
3246
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003247 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003248 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
3249 = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3250
3251 if (!Spec) {
3252 // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type.
3253 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3254 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3255 TypeAlignment);
3256 Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate,
3257 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003258 QualType(), QualType());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003259 Types.push_back(Spec);
3260 TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos);
3261 }
3262
3263 assert(Spec->isDependentType() &&
3264 "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type");
3265 return QualType(Spec, 0);
3266}
3267
3268QualType
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003269ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3270 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003271 QualType NamedType) const {
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003272 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003273 ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003274
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003275 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003276 ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003277 if (T)
3278 return QualType(T, 0);
3279
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003280 QualType Canon = NamedType;
3281 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3282 Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003283 ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3284 assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken");
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003285 (void)CheckT;
3286 }
3287
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003288 T = new (*this) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003289 Types.push_back(T);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003290 ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003291 return QualType(T, 0);
3292}
3293
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003294QualType
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003295ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const {
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003296 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3297 ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType);
3298
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003299 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003300 ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3301 if (T)
3302 return QualType(T, 0);
3303
3304 QualType Canon = InnerType;
3305 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3306 Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType);
3307 ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3308 assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken");
3309 (void)CheckT;
3310 }
3311
3312 T = new (*this) ParenType(InnerType, Canon);
3313 Types.push_back(T);
3314 ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3315 return QualType(T, 0);
3316}
3317
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003318QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3319 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3320 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003321 QualType Canon) const {
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003322 if (Canon.isNull()) {
3323 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003324 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3325 if (Keyword == ETK_None)
3326 CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3327
3328 if (CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword)
3329 Canon = getDependentNameType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003330 }
3331
3332 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003333 DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003334
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003335 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003336 DependentNameType *T
3337 = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003338 if (T)
3339 return QualType(T, 0);
3340
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003341 T = new (*this) DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003342 Types.push_back(T);
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003343 DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003344 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003345}
3346
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003347QualType
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003348ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3349 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003350 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003351 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003352 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args) const {
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003353 // TODO: avoid this copy
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003354 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003355 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I)
3356 ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument());
3357 return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name,
3358 ArgCopy.size(),
3359 ArgCopy.data());
3360}
3361
3362QualType
3363ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3364 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3365 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3366 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
3367 unsigned NumArgs,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003368 const TemplateArgument *Args) const {
Douglas Gregor6e068012011-02-28 00:04:36 +00003369 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
3370 "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003371
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003372 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003373 DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS,
3374 Name, NumArgs, Args);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003375
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003376 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003377 DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T
3378 = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003379 if (T)
3380 return QualType(T, 0);
3381
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003382 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003383
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003384 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3385 if (Keyword == ETK_None) CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3386
3387 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003388 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(NumArgs);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003389 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) {
3390 CanonArgs[I] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]);
3391 if (!CanonArgs[I].structurallyEquals(Args[I]))
3392 AnyNonCanonArgs = true;
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003393 }
3394
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003395 QualType Canon;
3396 if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) {
3397 Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS,
3398 Name, NumArgs,
3399 CanonArgs.data());
3400
3401 // Find the insert position again.
3402 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3403 }
3404
3405 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) +
3406 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3407 TypeAlignment);
John McCall773cc982010-06-11 11:07:21 +00003408 T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003409 Name, NumArgs, Args, Canon);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003410 Types.push_back(T);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003411 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003412 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003413}
3414
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003415QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,
David Blaikie05785d12013-02-20 22:23:23 +00003416 Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) {
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003417 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003418 PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003419
3420 assert(Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() &&
3421 "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs");
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003422 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003423 PackExpansionType *T
3424 = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3425 if (T)
3426 return QualType(T, 0);
3427
3428 QualType Canon;
3429 if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) {
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003430 Canon = getCanonicalType(Pattern);
3431 // The canonical type might not contain an unexpanded parameter pack, if it
3432 // contains an alias template specialization which ignores one of its
3433 // parameters.
3434 if (Canon->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) {
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00003435 Canon = getPackExpansionType(Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003436
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003437 // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into
3438 // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position.
3439 PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3440 }
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003441 }
3442
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003443 T = new (*this) PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003444 Types.push_back(T);
3445 PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00003446 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003447}
3448
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003449/// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols
3450/// alphabetically.
3451static bool CmpProtocolNames(const ObjCProtocolDecl *LHS,
3452 const ObjCProtocolDecl *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor77324f32008-11-17 14:58:09 +00003453 return LHS->getDeclName() < RHS->getDeclName();
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003454}
3455
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003456static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003457 unsigned NumProtocols) {
3458 if (NumProtocols == 0) return true;
3459
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003460 if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0])
3461 return false;
3462
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003463 for (unsigned i = 1; i != NumProtocols; ++i)
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003464 if (!CmpProtocolNames(Protocols[i-1], Protocols[i]) ||
3465 Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i])
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003466 return false;
3467 return true;
3468}
3469
3470static void SortAndUniqueProtocols(ObjCProtocolDecl **Protocols,
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003471 unsigned &NumProtocols) {
3472 ObjCProtocolDecl **ProtocolsEnd = Protocols+NumProtocols;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003473
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003474 // Sort protocols, keyed by name.
3475 std::sort(Protocols, Protocols+NumProtocols, CmpProtocolNames);
3476
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003477 // Canonicalize.
3478 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NumProtocols; I != N; ++I)
3479 Protocols[I] = Protocols[I]->getCanonicalDecl();
3480
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003481 // Remove duplicates.
3482 ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols, ProtocolsEnd);
3483 NumProtocols = ProtocolsEnd-Protocols;
3484}
3485
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003486QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,
3487 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003488 unsigned NumProtocols) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003489 // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols
3490 // to add, then the interface type will do just fine.
3491 if (!NumProtocols && isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(BaseType))
3492 return BaseType;
3493
3494 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003495 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003496 ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, BaseType, Protocols, NumProtocols);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003497 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003498 if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3499 return QualType(QT, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003500
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003501 // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and
3502 // a sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003503 QualType Canonical;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003504 bool ProtocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(Protocols, NumProtocols);
3505 if (!ProtocolsSorted || !BaseType.isCanonical()) {
3506 if (!ProtocolsSorted) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003507 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> Sorted(Protocols,
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00003508 Protocols + NumProtocols);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003509 unsigned UniqueCount = NumProtocols;
3510
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003511 SortAndUniqueProtocols(&Sorted[0], UniqueCount);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003512 Canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(BaseType),
3513 &Sorted[0], UniqueCount);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003514 } else {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003515 Canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(BaseType),
3516 Protocols, NumProtocols);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003517 }
3518
3519 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003520 ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3521 }
3522
3523 unsigned Size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl);
3524 Size += NumProtocols * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
3525 void *Mem = Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
3526 ObjCObjectTypeImpl *T =
3527 new (Mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(Canonical, BaseType, Protocols, NumProtocols);
3528
3529 Types.push_back(T);
3530 ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3531 return QualType(T, 0);
3532}
3533
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003534/// ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols - Checks that protocols in IC's
3535/// protocol list adopt all protocols in QT's qualified-id protocol
3536/// list.
3537bool ASTContext::ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT,
3538 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC) {
3539 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3540 return false;
3541
3542 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3543 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003544 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003545 if (!IC->ClassImplementsProtocol(Proto, false))
3546 return false;
3547 }
3548 return true;
3549 }
3550 return false;
3551}
3552
3553/// QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols - Checks that protocols in
3554/// QT's qualified-id protocol list adopt all protocols in IDecl's list
3555/// of protocols.
3556bool ASTContext::QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT,
3557 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl) {
3558 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3559 return false;
3560 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3561 if (!OPT)
3562 return false;
3563 if (!IDecl->hasDefinition())
3564 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00003565 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocols;
3566 CollectInheritedProtocols(IDecl, InheritedProtocols);
3567 if (InheritedProtocols.empty())
3568 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00003569 // Check that if every protocol in list of id<plist> conforms to a protcol
3570 // of IDecl's, then bridge casting is ok.
3571 bool Conforms = false;
3572 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
3573 Conforms = false;
3574 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
3575 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(Proto, PI)) {
3576 Conforms = true;
3577 break;
3578 }
3579 }
3580 if (!Conforms)
3581 break;
3582 }
3583 if (Conforms)
3584 return true;
3585
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003586 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003587 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
3588 bool Adopts = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003589 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00003590 // return 'true' if 'PI' is in the inheritance hierarchy of Proto
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003591 if ((Adopts = ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(PI, Proto)))
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003592 break;
3593 }
3594 if (!Adopts)
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00003595 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003596 }
3597 return true;
3598}
3599
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003600/// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for
3601/// the given object type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003602QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003603 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3604 ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT);
3605
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003606 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003607 if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT =
3608 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3609 return QualType(QT, 0);
3610
3611 // Find the canonical object type.
3612 QualType Canonical;
3613 if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) {
3614 Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT));
3615
3616 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003617 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3618 }
3619
Douglas Gregorf85bee62010-02-08 22:59:26 +00003620 // No match.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003621 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), TypeAlignment);
3622 ObjCObjectPointerType *QType =
3623 new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003624
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003625 Types.push_back(QType);
3626 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003627 return QualType(QType, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003628}
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003629
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003630/// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3631/// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional.
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003632QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl,
3633 ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const {
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003634 if (Decl->TypeForDecl)
3635 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003636
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003637 if (PrevDecl) {
3638 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl");
3639 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3640 return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3641 }
3642
Douglas Gregor7671e532011-12-16 16:34:57 +00003643 // Prefer the definition, if there is one.
3644 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition())
3645 Decl = Def;
3646
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003647 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), TypeAlignment);
3648 ObjCInterfaceType *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
3649 Decl->TypeForDecl = T;
3650 Types.push_back(T);
3651 return QualType(T, 0);
Fariborz Jahanian70e8f102007-10-11 00:55:41 +00003652}
3653
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003654/// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique
3655/// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example,
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003656/// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003657/// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003658/// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003659QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003660 TypeOfExprType *toe;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003661 if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
3662 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3663 DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003664
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003665 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003666 DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon
3667 = DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3668 if (Canon) {
3669 // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent
3670 // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003671 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr,
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003672 QualType((TypeOfExprType*)Canon, 0));
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00003673 } else {
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003674 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003675 Canon
3676 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr);
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003677 DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
3678 toe = Canon;
3679 }
3680 } else {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003681 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003682 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, Canonical);
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003683 }
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003684 Types.push_back(toe);
3685 return QualType(toe, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003686}
3687
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003688/// getTypeOfType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003689/// TypeOfType nodes. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003690/// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003691/// an issue. This doesn't affect the type checker, since it operates
3692/// on canonical types (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003693QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00003694 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003695 TypeOfType *tot = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfType(tofType, Canonical);
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003696 Types.push_back(tot);
3697 return QualType(tot, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003698}
3699
Anders Carlssonad6bd352009-06-24 21:24:56 +00003700
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003701/// \brief Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique DecltypeType
3702/// nodes. This would never be helpful, since each such type has its own
3703/// expression, and would not give a significant memory saving, since there
3704/// is an Expr tree under each such type.
Douglas Gregor81495f32012-02-12 18:42:33 +00003705QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003706 DecltypeType *dt;
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003707
3708 // C++11 [temp.type]p2:
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00003709 // If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003710 // unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same
3711 // type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1).
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00003712 if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003713 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3714 DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003715
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003716 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003717 DependentDecltypeType *Canon
3718 = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003719 if (!Canon) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003720 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003721 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentDecltypeType(*this, e);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003722 DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003723 }
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003724 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3725 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, QualType((DecltypeType *)Canon, 0));
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003726 } else {
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003727 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3728 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003729 }
Anders Carlsson81df7b82009-06-24 19:06:50 +00003730 Types.push_back(dt);
3731 return QualType(dt, 0);
3732}
3733
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00003734/// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory
3735/// savings are minimal and these are rare.
3736QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,
3737 QualType UnderlyingType,
3738 UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind)
3739 const {
3740 UnaryTransformType *Ty =
Douglas Gregor6c6e6762011-05-25 17:51:54 +00003741 new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType, UnderlyingType,
3742 Kind,
3743 UnderlyingType->isDependentType() ?
Peter Collingbourne15d48ec2012-03-05 16:02:06 +00003744 QualType() : getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00003745 Types.push_back(Ty);
3746 return QualType(Ty, 0);
3747}
3748
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003749/// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been
3750/// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the
3751/// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type.
3752QualType ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, bool IsDecltypeAuto,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003753 bool IsDependent) const {
3754 if (DeducedType.isNull() && !IsDecltypeAuto && !IsDependent)
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003755 return getAutoDeductType();
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003756
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003757 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003758 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003759 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003760 AutoType::Profile(ID, DeducedType, IsDecltypeAuto, IsDependent);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003761 if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3762 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00003763
Richard Smith74aeef52013-04-26 16:15:35 +00003764 AutoType *AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(DeducedType,
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00003765 IsDecltypeAuto,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003766 IsDependent);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00003767 Types.push_back(AT);
3768 if (InsertPos)
3769 AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
3770 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00003771}
3772
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003773/// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for
3774/// the given value type.
3775QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const {
3776 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
3777 // structure.
3778 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3779 AtomicType::Profile(ID, T);
3780
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003781 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003782 if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3783 return QualType(AT, 0);
3784
3785 // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3786 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3787 QualType Canonical;
3788 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
3789 Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T));
3790
3791 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3792 AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003793 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003794 }
3795 AtomicType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AtomicType(T, Canonical);
3796 Types.push_back(New);
3797 AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3798 return QualType(New, 0);
3799}
3800
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00003801/// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'.
3802QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const {
3803 if (AutoDeductTy.isNull())
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003804 AutoDeductTy = QualType(
3805 new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(QualType(), /*decltype(auto)*/false,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003806 /*dependent*/false),
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003807 0);
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00003808 return AutoDeductTy;
3809}
3810
3811/// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'.
3812QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const {
3813 if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull())
3814 AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType());
3815 assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern");
3816 return AutoRRefDeductTy;
3817}
3818
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003819/// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3820/// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003821QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const {
Ted Kremenek2b0ce112007-11-26 21:16:01 +00003822 assert (Decl);
Mike Stumpb93185d2009-08-07 18:05:12 +00003823 // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting
3824 // away const? mutable?
3825 return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl));
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003826}
3827
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003828/// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result
3829/// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and
3830/// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>.
Anders Carlsson22f443f2009-12-12 00:26:23 +00003831CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00003832 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType());
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00003833}
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003834
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00003835/// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
3836CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const {
3837 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType());
3838}
3839
3840/// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
3841CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const {
3842 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType());
3843}
3844
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00003845/// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t".
3846/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
3847QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const {
3848 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
3849 return WCharTy;
3850}
3851
3852/// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t".
3853/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
3854QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const {
3855 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
3856 return UnsignedIntTy;
3857}
3858
Enea Zaffanellaf11ceb62013-01-26 17:08:37 +00003859QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const {
3860 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType());
3861}
3862
3863QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const {
3864 return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType());
3865}
3866
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00003867/// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17)
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00003868/// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9).
3869QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00003870 return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(0));
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00003871}
3872
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00003873/// \brief Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in
3874/// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork().
3875QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const {
3876 return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType());
3877}
3878
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00003879//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3880// Type Operators
3881//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3882
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003883CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const {
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003884 // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining
3885 // qualifiers.
3886 T = getCanonicalType(T);
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003887 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003888 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003889 QualType Result;
3890 if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
3891 Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0));
3892 } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) {
3893 Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0));
3894 } else {
3895 Result = QualType(Ty, 0);
3896 }
3897
3898 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result);
3899}
3900
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003901QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,
3902 Qualifiers &quals) {
3903 SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType();
3904
3905 // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to
3906 // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor.
3907 // We then have to strip that sugar back off with
3908 // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly.
3909 const ArrayType *AT =
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003910 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003911
3912 // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType.
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003913 if (!AT) {
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003914 quals = splitType.Quals;
3915 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003916 }
3917
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003918 // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type.
3919 QualType elementType = AT->getElementType();
3920 QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals);
3921
3922 // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we
3923 // can just use the results in splitType.
3924 if (elementType == unqualElementType) {
3925 assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003926 quals = splitType.Quals;
3927 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003928 }
3929
3930 // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then
3931 // build the type back up.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003932 quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003933
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003934 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003935 return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003936 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
3937 }
3938
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003939 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003940 return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003941 }
3942
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003943 if (const VariableArrayType *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003944 return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00003945 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003946 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
3947 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
3948 VAT->getBracketsRange());
3949 }
3950
3951 const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003952 return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003953 DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0,
3954 SourceRange());
3955}
3956
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003957/// UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes - If T1 and T2 are pointer types that
3958/// may be similar (C++ 4.4), replaces T1 and T2 with the type that
3959/// they point to and return true. If T1 and T2 aren't pointer types
3960/// or pointer-to-member types, or if they are not similar at this
3961/// level, returns false and leaves T1 and T2 unchanged. Top-level
3962/// qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored. This function will typically
3963/// be called in a loop that successively "unwraps" pointer and
3964/// pointer-to-member types to compare them at each level.
3965bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) {
3966 const PointerType *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>(),
3967 *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>();
3968 if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) {
3969 T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType();
3970 T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType();
3971 return true;
3972 }
3973
3974 const MemberPointerType *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
3975 *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3976 if (T1MPType && T2MPType &&
3977 hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0),
3978 QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) {
3979 T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType();
3980 T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType();
3981 return true;
3982 }
3983
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00003984 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003985 const ObjCObjectPointerType *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
3986 *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3987 if (T1OPType && T2OPType) {
3988 T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType();
3989 T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType();
3990 return true;
3991 }
3992 }
3993
3994 // FIXME: Block pointers, too?
3995
3996 return false;
3997}
3998
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003999DeclarationNameInfo
4000ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,
4001 SourceLocation NameLoc) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004002 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4003 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4004 case TemplateName::Template:
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004005 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004006 return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(),
4007 NameLoc);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004008
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004009 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: {
4010 OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate();
4011 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
4012 return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
4013 }
4014
4015 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4016 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004017 DeclarationName DName;
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004018 if (DTN->isIdentifier()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004019 DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier());
4020 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004021 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004022 DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator());
4023 // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations?
4024 DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc;
4025 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4026 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4027 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004028 }
4029 }
4030
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004031 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4032 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4033 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4034 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(),
4035 NameLoc);
4036 }
4037
4038 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4039 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4040 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4041 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(),
4042 NameLoc);
4043 }
4044 }
4045
4046 llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!");
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004047}
4048
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004049TemplateName ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004050 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4051 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4052 case TemplateName::Template: {
4053 TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004054 if (TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004055 = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template))
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004056 Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP);
4057
4058 // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6b7e3762009-07-18 00:34:25 +00004059 return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl()));
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004060 }
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004061
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004062 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate:
4063 llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize overloaded template");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004064
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004065 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4066 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
4067 assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls.");
4068 return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName;
4069 }
4070
4071 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4072 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4073 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4074 return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement());
4075 }
4076
4077 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4078 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4079 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4080 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *canonParameter
4081 = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(subst->getParameterPack());
4082 TemplateArgument canonArgPack
4083 = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack());
4084 return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(canonParameter, canonArgPack);
4085 }
4086 }
4087
4088 llvm_unreachable("bad template name!");
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004089}
4090
Douglas Gregoradee3e32009-11-11 23:06:43 +00004091bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) {
4092 X = getCanonicalTemplateName(X);
4093 Y = getCanonicalTemplateName(Y);
4094 return X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer();
4095}
4096
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004097TemplateArgument
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004098ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const {
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004099 switch (Arg.getKind()) {
4100 case TemplateArgument::Null:
4101 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004102
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004103 case TemplateArgument::Expression:
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004104 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004105
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004106 case TemplateArgument::Declaration: {
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004107 ValueDecl *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
4108 return TemplateArgument(D, Arg.isDeclForReferenceParam());
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004109 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004110
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004111 case TemplateArgument::NullPtr:
4112 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()),
4113 /*isNullPtr*/true);
4114
Douglas Gregor9167f8b2009-11-11 01:00:40 +00004115 case TemplateArgument::Template:
4116 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate()));
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004117
4118 case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion:
4119 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(
4120 Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()),
Douglas Gregore1d60df2011-01-14 23:41:42 +00004121 Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions());
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004122
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004123 case TemplateArgument::Integral:
Benjamin Kramer6003ad52012-06-07 15:09:51 +00004124 return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004125
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004126 case TemplateArgument::Type:
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00004127 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004128
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004129 case TemplateArgument::Pack: {
Douglas Gregor0192c232010-12-20 16:52:59 +00004130 if (Arg.pack_size() == 0)
4131 return Arg;
4132
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00004133 TemplateArgument *CanonArgs
4134 = new (*this) TemplateArgument[Arg.pack_size()];
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004135 unsigned Idx = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004136 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator A = Arg.pack_begin(),
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004137 AEnd = Arg.pack_end();
4138 A != AEnd; (void)++A, ++Idx)
4139 CanonArgs[Idx] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(*A);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004140
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00004141 return TemplateArgument(CanonArgs, Arg.pack_size());
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004142 }
4143 }
4144
4145 // Silence GCC warning
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004146 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind");
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004147}
4148
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004149NestedNameSpecifier *
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004150ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004151 if (!NNS)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004152 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004153
4154 switch (NNS->getKind()) {
4155 case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
4156 // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004157 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this,
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004158 getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()),
4159 NNS->getAsIdentifier());
4160
4161 case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
4162 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4163 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004164 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004165 NNS->getAsNamespace()->getOriginalNamespace());
4166
4167 case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
4168 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4169 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004170 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004171 NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace()
4172 ->getOriginalNamespace());
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004173
4174 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
4175 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: {
4176 QualType T = getCanonicalType(QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004177
4178 // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"),
4179 // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those
4180 // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize
4181 // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name
4182 // types, e.g.,
4183 // typedef typename T::type T1;
4184 // typedef typename T1::type T2;
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004185 if (const DependentNameType *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>())
4186 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(),
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004187 const_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(DNT->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004188
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004189 // Otherwise, just canonicalize the type, and force it to be a TypeSpec.
4190 // FIXME: Why are TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate distinct in the
4191 // first place?
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004192 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, false,
4193 const_cast<Type *>(T.getTypePtr()));
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004194 }
4195
4196 case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
4197 // The global specifier is canonical and unique.
4198 return NNS;
4199 }
4200
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00004201 llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!");
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004202}
4203
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004204
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004205const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004206 // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004207 if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004208 // Handle the common positive case fast.
4209 if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T))
4210 return AT;
4211 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004212
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004213 // Handle the common negative case fast.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004214 if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004215 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004216
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004217 // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type. This
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004218 // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes
4219 // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type."
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004220
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004221 // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have
4222 // sugar such as a typedef in the way. If we have type qualifiers on the type
Douglas Gregor2211d342009-08-05 05:36:45 +00004223 // we must propagate them down into the element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004224
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004225 SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004226 Qualifiers qs = split.Quals;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004227
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004228 // If we have a simple case, just return now.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004229 const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004230 if (!ATy || qs.empty())
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004231 return ATy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004232
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004233 // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it. Push the
4234 // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004235 QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004236
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004237 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy))
4238 return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(),
4239 CAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004240 CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004241 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy))
4242 return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy,
4243 IAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004244 IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004245
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004246 if (const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004247 = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy))
4248 return cast<ArrayType>(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004249 getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004250 DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004251 DSAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004252 DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004253 DSAT->getBracketsRange()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004254
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004255 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy);
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004256 return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004257 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004258 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004259 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004260 VAT->getBracketsRange()));
Chris Lattnered0d0792008-04-06 22:41:35 +00004261}
4262
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004263QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const {
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00004264 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4265 return getDecayedType(T);
4266 return T;
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004267}
4268
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004269QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004270 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4271 T = getAdjustedParameterType(T);
4272 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4273}
4274
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004275/// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the
4276/// specified array type to a pointer. This operation is non-trivial when
4277/// handling typedefs etc. The canonical type of "T" must be an array type,
4278/// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array.
4279///
4280/// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004281QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004282 // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any
4283 // typedefs in the element type of the array. This also handles propagation
4284 // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present
4285 // (C99 6.7.3p8).
4286 const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty);
4287 assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004288
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004289 QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004290
4291 // int x[restrict 4] -> int *restrict
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004292 return getQualifiedType(PtrTy, PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004293}
4294
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004295QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const {
4296 return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor79f83ed2009-07-23 23:49:00 +00004297}
4298
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004299QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const {
4300 Qualifiers qs;
4301 while (true) {
4302 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004303 const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe();
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004304 if (!array) break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004305
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004306 type = array->getElementType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004307 qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004308 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004309
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004310 return getQualifiedType(type, qs);
Anders Carlssone0808df2008-12-21 03:44:36 +00004311}
4312
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004313/// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004314uint64_t
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004315ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA) const {
4316 uint64_t ElementCount = 1;
4317 do {
4318 ElementCount *= CA->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Smith7808c6a2012-12-06 03:04:50 +00004319 CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>(
4320 CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe());
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004321 } while (CA);
4322 return ElementCount;
4323}
4324
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004325/// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types.
4326/// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float.
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004327static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004328 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004329 return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004330
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004331 assert(T->getAs<BuiltinType>() && "getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
4332 switch (T->getAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004333 default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00004334 case BuiltinType::Half: return HalfRank;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004335 case BuiltinType::Float: return FloatRank;
4336 case BuiltinType::Double: return DoubleRank;
4337 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004338 }
4339}
4340
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004341/// getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain - Returns a real floating
4342/// point or a complex type (based on typeDomain/typeSize).
Steve Narofffc6ffa22007-08-27 01:41:48 +00004343/// 'typeDomain' is a real floating point or complex type.
4344/// 'typeSize' is a real floating point or complex type.
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004345QualType ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size,
4346 QualType Domain) const {
4347 FloatingRank EltRank = getFloatingRank(Size);
4348 if (Domain->isComplexType()) {
4349 switch (EltRank) {
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004350 case HalfRank: llvm_unreachable("Complex half is not supported");
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004351 case FloatRank: return FloatComplexTy;
4352 case DoubleRank: return DoubleComplexTy;
4353 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleComplexTy;
4354 }
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004355 }
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004356
4357 assert(Domain->isRealFloatingType() && "Unknown domain!");
4358 switch (EltRank) {
Joey Goulydd7f4562013-01-23 11:56:20 +00004359 case HalfRank: return HalfTy;
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004360 case FloatRank: return FloatTy;
4361 case DoubleRank: return DoubleTy;
4362 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleTy;
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004363 }
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004364 llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): illegal value for rank");
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004365}
4366
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004367/// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating
4368/// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' ==
4369/// '_Complex double'). If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004370/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004371int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004372 FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS);
4373 FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004374
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004375 if (LHSR == RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004376 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004377 if (LHSR > RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004378 return 1;
4379 return -1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004380}
4381
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004382/// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This
4383/// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum,
4384/// or if it is not canonicalized.
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004385unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00004386 assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized");
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00004387
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004388 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004389 default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer");
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004390 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004391 return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004392 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
4393 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
4394 case BuiltinType::SChar:
4395 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004396 return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004397 case BuiltinType::Short:
4398 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004399 return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004400 case BuiltinType::Int:
4401 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004402 return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004403 case BuiltinType::Long:
4404 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004405 return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004406 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
4407 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004408 return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00004409 case BuiltinType::Int128:
4410 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
4411 return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3);
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004412 }
4413}
4414
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004415/// \brief Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according
4416/// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions).
4417///
4418/// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no
4419/// promotion occurs.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004420QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const {
Douglas Gregore05d3cb2010-05-24 20:13:53 +00004421 if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent())
4422 return QualType();
4423
John McCalld25db7e2013-05-06 21:39:12 +00004424 FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields?
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004425 if (!Field)
4426 return QualType();
4427
4428 QualType FT = Field->getType();
4429
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00004430 uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004431 uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy);
4432 // GCC extension compatibility: if the bit-field size is less than or equal
4433 // to the size of int, it gets promoted no matter what its type is.
4434 // For instance, unsigned long bf : 4 gets promoted to signed int.
4435 if (BitWidth < IntSize)
4436 return IntTy;
4437
4438 if (BitWidth == IntSize)
4439 return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4440
4441 // Types bigger than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act
4442 // like the base type.
4443 // FIXME: This doesn't quite match what gcc does, but what gcc does here
4444 // is ridiculous.
4445 return QualType();
4446}
4447
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004448/// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will
4449/// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable
4450/// integer type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004451QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004452 assert(!Promotable.isNull());
4453 assert(Promotable->isPromotableIntegerType());
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00004454 if (const EnumType *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>())
4455 return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType();
Eli Friedman3f37c1c2011-10-26 07:22:48 +00004456
4457 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
4458 // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t
4459 // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following
4460 // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type:
4461 // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or
4462 // unsigned long long int [...]
4463 // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this?
4464 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S ||
4465 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U ||
4466 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 ||
4467 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) {
4468 bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S;
4469 uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT);
4470 QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy,
4471 LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy };
4472 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < llvm::array_lengthof(PromoteTypes); ++Idx) {
4473 uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
4474 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
4475 (FromSize == ToSize &&
4476 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType()))
4477 return PromoteTypes[Idx];
4478 }
4479 llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long");
4480 }
4481 }
4482
4483 // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type.
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004484 if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType())
4485 return IntTy;
Eli Friedman6745c3b2012-11-15 01:21:59 +00004486 uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable);
4487 uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy);
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004488 assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize);
4489 return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4490}
4491
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004492/// \brief Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable
4493/// type and returns its ownership.
4494Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const {
4495 while (!T.isNull()) {
4496 if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None)
4497 return T.getObjCLifetime();
4498 if (T->isArrayType())
4499 T = getBaseElementType(T);
4500 else if (const PointerType *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
4501 T = PT->getPointeeType();
4502 else if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis8e252532011-07-01 23:01:46 +00004503 T = RT->getPointeeType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004504 else
4505 break;
4506 }
4507
4508 return Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4509}
4510
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004511static const Type *getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType *ET) {
4512 // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types.
4513 // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types.
4514 if (ET->getDecl()->isComplete() && !ET->getDecl()->isScoped())
4515 return ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004516 return nullptr;
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004517}
4518
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004519/// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type:
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004520/// C99 6.3.1.8p1. If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004521/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004522int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004523 const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr();
4524 const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr();
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004525
4526 // Unwrap enums to their underlying type.
4527 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(LHSC))
4528 LHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4529 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(RHSC))
4530 RHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4531
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004532 if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004533
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004534 bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
4535 bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004536
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004537 unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC);
4538 unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004539
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004540 if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) { // Both signed or both unsigned.
4541 if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0;
4542 return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1;
4543 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004544
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004545 // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa.
4546 if (LHSUnsigned) {
4547 // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it.
4548 if (LHSRank >= RHSRank)
4549 return 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004550
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004551 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4552 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004553 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004554 return -1;
4555 }
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004556
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004557 // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it.
4558 if (RHSRank >= LHSRank)
4559 return -1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004560
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004561 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4562 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004563 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004564 return 1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004565}
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004566
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004567// getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004568QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const {
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004569 if (!CFConstantStringTypeDecl) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004570 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("NSConstantString");
John McCallae580fe2010-02-05 01:33:36 +00004571 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->startDefinition();
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004572
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004573 QualType FieldTypes[4];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004574
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004575 // const int *isa;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004576 FieldTypes[0] = getPointerType(IntTy.withConst());
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004577 // int flags;
4578 FieldTypes[1] = IntTy;
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004579 // const char *str;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004580 FieldTypes[2] = getPointerType(CharTy.withConst());
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004581 // long length;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004582 FieldTypes[3] = LongTy;
4583
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004584 // Create fields
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004585 for (unsigned i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004586 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTypeDecl,
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +00004587 SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004588 SourceLocation(), nullptr,
4589 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4590 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Richard Smith938f40b2011-06-11 17:19:42 +00004591 /*Mutable=*/false,
Richard Smith2b013182012-06-10 03:12:00 +00004592 ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004593 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004594 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->addDecl(Field);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004595 }
4596
Douglas Gregord5058122010-02-11 01:19:42 +00004597 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->completeDefinition();
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004598 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004599
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004600 return getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTypeDecl);
Gabor Greif412af032007-09-11 15:32:40 +00004601}
Anders Carlsson87c149b2007-10-11 01:00:40 +00004602
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00004603QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const {
4604 if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004605 RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("objc_super");
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00004606 TUDecl->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4607 ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4608 }
4609 return ObjCSuperType;
4610}
4611
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004612void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004613 const RecordType *Rec = T->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004614 assert(Rec && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
4615 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = Rec->getDecl();
4616}
4617
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004618QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004619 if (BlockDescriptorType)
4620 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4621
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004622 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004623 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004624 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor");
4625 RD->startDefinition();
4626
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004627 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4628 UnsignedLongTy,
4629 UnsignedLongTy,
4630 };
4631
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00004632 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004633 "reserved",
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004634 "Size"
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004635 };
4636
4637 for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004638 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
4639 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004640 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4641 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004642 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004643 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004644 }
4645
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004646 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004647
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004648 BlockDescriptorType = RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004649
4650 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4651}
4652
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004653QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004654 if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType)
4655 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4656
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004657 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004658 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004659 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose");
4660 RD->startDefinition();
4661
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004662 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4663 UnsignedLongTy,
4664 UnsignedLongTy,
4665 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy),
4666 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy)
4667 };
4668
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00004669 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004670 "reserved",
4671 "Size",
4672 "CopyFuncPtr",
4673 "DestroyFuncPtr"
4674 };
4675
4676 for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004677 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
4678 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004679 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4680 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004681 /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004682 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004683 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004684 }
4685
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004686 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004687
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004688 BlockDescriptorExtendedType = RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004689 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4690}
4691
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00004692/// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty"
4693/// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic
4694/// in buildByrefHelpers.
4695bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,
4696 const VarDecl *D) {
4697 if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
4698 const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInits(D);
4699 if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false;
4700
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00004701 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniana00076c2010-11-17 00:21:28 +00004702 }
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00004703
4704 if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false;
4705
4706 Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers();
4707
4708 // If we have lifetime, that dominates.
4709 if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) {
4710 assert(getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
4711
4712 switch (lifetime) {
4713 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible");
4714
4715 // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned.
4716 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
4717 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
4718 return false;
4719
4720 // Tell the runtime that this is ARC __weak, called by the
4721 // byref routines.
4722 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
4723 // ARC __strong __block variables need to be retained.
4724 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
4725 return true;
4726 }
4727 llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!");
4728 }
4729 return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) ||
4730 Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType());
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00004731}
4732
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00004733bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,
4734 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime,
4735 bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const {
4736
4737 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1 ||
4738 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
4739 return false;
4740
4741 HasByrefExtendedLayout = false;
Fariborz Jahanianf762b722012-12-11 19:58:01 +00004742 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00004743 HasByrefExtendedLayout = true;
4744 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4745 }
4746 else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
4747 LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime();
4748 // MRR.
4749 else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
4750 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
4751 else
4752 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4753 return true;
4754}
4755
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00004756TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() {
4757 if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl)
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00004758 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl =
4759 buildImplicitTypedef(getObjCIdType(), "instancetype");
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00004760 return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl;
4761}
4762
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00004763// This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL:
4764// typedef <type> BOOL;
Chris Lattnere0218992007-10-30 20:27:44 +00004765static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) {
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00004766 if (const TypedefType *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T))
Chris Lattner9b1f2792008-11-24 03:52:59 +00004767 if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
4768 return II->isStr("BOOL");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004769
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00004770 return false;
4771}
4772
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00004773/// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004774/// purpose.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004775CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const {
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004776 if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType())
4777 return CharUnits::Zero();
4778
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004779 CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004780
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004781 // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004782 if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004783 sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy));
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004784 // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in.
4785 else if (type->isArrayType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004786 sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004787 return sz;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004788}
4789
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00004790bool ASTContext::isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(const VarDecl *VD) const {
4791 return getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
4792 VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
4793 !VD->getFirstDecl()->isOutOfLine() && VD->getFirstDecl()->hasInit();
4794}
4795
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004796static inline
4797std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) {
4798 return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity());
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004799}
4800
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004801/// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004802/// declaration.
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004803std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const {
4804 std::string S;
4805
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004806 const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl();
4807 QualType BlockTy =
4808 Expr->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4809 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00004810 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004811 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(
4812 Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S,
4813 true /*Extended*/);
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00004814 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004815 getObjCEncodingForType(BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004816 // Compute size of all parameters.
4817 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
4818 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
4819 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004820 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
4821 CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize;
Aaron Ballmanb2b8b1d2014-03-07 16:09:59 +00004822 for (auto PI : Decl->params()) {
4823 QualType PType = PI->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004824 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahaniand4879412012-06-30 00:48:59 +00004825 if (sz.isZero())
4826 continue;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004827 assert (sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004828 ParmOffset += sz;
4829 }
4830 // Size of the argument frame
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004831 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004832 // Block pointer and offset.
4833 S += "@?0";
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004834
4835 // Argument types.
4836 ParmOffset = PtrSize;
Aaron Ballmanb2b8b1d2014-03-07 16:09:59 +00004837 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) {
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004838 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
4839 if (const ArrayType *AT =
4840 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4841 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4842 // elements.
4843 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
4844 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4845 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4846 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00004847 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00004848 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType,
4849 S, true /*Extended*/);
4850 else
4851 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004852 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004853 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004854 }
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004855
4856 return S;
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004857}
4858
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004859bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl,
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004860 std::string& S) {
4861 // Encode result type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004862 getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004863 CharUnits ParmOffset;
4864 // Compute size of all parameters.
Aaron Ballmanf6bf62e2014-03-07 15:12:56 +00004865 for (auto PI : Decl->params()) {
4866 QualType PType = PI->getType();
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004867 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004868 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00004869 continue;
4870
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004871 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004872 "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004873 ParmOffset += sz;
4874 }
4875 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
4876 ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero();
4877
4878 // Argument types.
Aaron Ballmanf6bf62e2014-03-07 15:12:56 +00004879 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) {
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004880 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
4881 if (const ArrayType *AT =
4882 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4883 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4884 // elements.
4885 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
4886 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4887 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4888 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4889 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
4890 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
4891 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
4892 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004893
4894 return false;
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004895}
4896
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004897/// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single
4898/// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and
4899/// block object types.
4900void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
4901 QualType T, std::string& S,
4902 bool Extended) const {
4903 // Encode type qualifer, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter.
4904 getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S);
4905 // Encode parameter type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004906 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004907 true /*OutermostType*/,
4908 false /*EncodingProperty*/,
4909 false /*StructField*/,
4910 Extended /*EncodeBlockParameters*/,
4911 Extended /*EncodeClassNames*/);
4912}
4913
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00004914/// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004915/// declaration.
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004916bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004917 std::string& S,
4918 bool Extended) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004919 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004920 // Encode return type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004921 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
4922 Decl->getReturnType(), S, Extended);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004923 // Compute size of all parameters.
4924 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
4925 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
4926 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004927 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004928 // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for
4929 // their size.
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004930 CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00004931 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00004932 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Chris Lattnera4997152009-02-20 18:43:26 +00004933 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004934 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004935 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00004936 continue;
4937
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004938 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
4939 "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type");
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004940 ParmOffset += sz;
4941 }
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004942 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004943 S += "@0:";
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004944 S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004945
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004946 // Argument types.
4947 ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00004948 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00004949 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00004950 const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004951 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
Fariborz Jahaniana0befc02008-12-20 23:29:59 +00004952 if (const ArrayType *AT =
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00004953 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4954 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4955 // elements.
Steve Naroff323827e2009-04-14 00:40:09 +00004956 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00004957 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4958 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4959 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004960 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
4961 PType, S, Extended);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004962 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004963 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004964 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004965
4966 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004967}
4968
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00004969ObjCPropertyImplDecl *
4970ASTContext::getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(
4971 const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
4972 const Decl *Container) const {
4973 if (!Container)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004974 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00004975 if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CID =
4976 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) {
Aaron Ballmand85eff42014-03-14 15:02:45 +00004977 for (auto *PID : CID->property_impls())
4978 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
4979 return PID;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004980 } else {
4981 const ObjCImplementationDecl *OID=cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container);
4982 for (auto *PID : OID->property_impls())
4983 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
4984 return PID;
4985 }
4986 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00004987}
4988
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004989/// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00004990/// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004991/// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be
4992/// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004993/// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple
4994/// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The
4995/// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are
4996/// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types
4997/// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00004998/// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration:
4999/// @code
5000/// enum PropertyAttributes {
5001/// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R', // property is read-only.
5002/// kPropertyBycopy = 'C', // property is a copy of the value last assigned
5003/// kPropertyByref = '&', // property is a reference to the value last assigned
5004/// kPropertyDynamic = 'D', // property is dynamic
5005/// kPropertyGetter = 'G', // followed by getter selector name
5006/// kPropertySetter = 'S', // followed by setter selector name
5007/// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V' // followed by instance variable name
Bob Wilson8cf61852012-03-22 17:48:02 +00005008/// kPropertyType = 'T' // followed by old-style type encoding.
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00005009/// kPropertyWeak = 'W' // 'weak' property
5010/// kPropertyStrong = 'P' // property GC'able
5011/// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N' // property non-atomic
5012/// };
5013/// @endcode
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005014void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005015 const Decl *Container,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005016 std::string& S) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005017 // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s).
5018 bool Dynamic = false;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005019 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = nullptr;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005020
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005021 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropertyImpDecl =
5022 getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(PD, Container)) {
5023 if (PropertyImpDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
5024 Dynamic = true;
5025 else
5026 SynthesizePID = PropertyImpDecl;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005027 }
5028
5029 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
5030 S = "T";
5031
5032 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005033 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5034 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00005035 getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(PD->getType(), S);
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005036
5037 if (PD->isReadOnly()) {
5038 S += ",R";
Nico Weber4e8626f2013-05-08 23:47:40 +00005039 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_copy)
5040 S += ",C";
5041 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_retain)
5042 S += ",&";
Fariborz Jahanian33079ee2014-04-02 22:49:42 +00005043 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_weak)
5044 S += ",W";
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005045 } else {
5046 switch (PD->getSetterKind()) {
5047 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break;
5048 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy: S += ",C"; break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005049 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break;
Fariborz Jahanian70a315c2011-08-12 20:47:08 +00005050 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak: S += ",W"; break;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005051 }
5052 }
5053
5054 // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties
5055 // are "dynamic by default".
5056 if (Dynamic)
5057 S += ",D";
5058
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005059 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_nonatomic)
5060 S += ",N";
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005061
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005062 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_getter) {
5063 S += ",G";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005064 S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005065 }
5066
5067 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_setter) {
5068 S += ",S";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005069 S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005070 }
5071
5072 if (SynthesizePID) {
5073 const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl();
5074 S += ",V";
Chris Lattner1cbaacc2008-11-24 04:00:27 +00005075 S += OID->getNameAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005076 }
5077
5078 // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong
5079}
5080
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005081/// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding -
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005082/// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as
5083/// 'l' or 'L' , but not always. For typedefs, we need to use
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005084/// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer!
5085///
5086void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const {
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005087 if (isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005088 if (const BuiltinType *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005089 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005090 PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005091 else
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005092 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005093 PointeeTy = IntTy;
5094 }
5095 }
5096}
5097
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005098void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005099 const FieldDecl *Field) const {
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005100 // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are
5101 // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that
5102 // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the
5103 // same type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005104 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, Field,
Fariborz Jahaniandaef00b2008-12-22 23:22:27 +00005105 true /* outermost type */);
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005106}
5107
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00005108void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(QualType T,
5109 std::string& S) const {
5110 // Encode result type.
5111 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5112 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
5113 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
5114 true /* outermost type */,
5115 true /* encoding property */);
5116}
5117
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005118static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(const ASTContext *C,
5119 BuiltinType::Kind kind) {
5120 switch (kind) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005121 case BuiltinType::Void: return 'v';
5122 case BuiltinType::Bool: return 'B';
5123 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
5124 case BuiltinType::UChar: return 'C';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005125 case BuiltinType::Char16:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005126 case BuiltinType::UShort: return 'S';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005127 case BuiltinType::Char32:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005128 case BuiltinType::UInt: return 'I';
5129 case BuiltinType::ULong:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005130 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005131 case BuiltinType::UInt128: return 'T';
5132 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: return 'Q';
5133 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
5134 case BuiltinType::SChar: return 'c';
5135 case BuiltinType::Short: return 's';
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00005136 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
5137 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005138 case BuiltinType::Int: return 'i';
5139 case BuiltinType::Long:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005140 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005141 case BuiltinType::LongLong: return 'q';
5142 case BuiltinType::Int128: return 't';
5143 case BuiltinType::Float: return 'f';
5144 case BuiltinType::Double: return 'd';
Daniel Dunbar7cba5a72010-10-11 21:13:48 +00005145 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005146 case BuiltinType::NullPtr: return '*'; // like char*
5147
5148 case BuiltinType::Half:
5149 // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these!
5150 return ' ';
5151
5152 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
5153 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
5154 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
5155 llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type");
5156
5157 // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings.
5158 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
5159 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
5160 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
5161 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
5162 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
5163 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00005164 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00005165 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005166 case BuiltinType::Dependent:
5167#define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID)
5168#define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \
5169 case BuiltinType::KIND:
5170#include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
5171 llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005172 }
David Blaikie5a6a0202013-01-09 17:48:41 +00005173 llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005174}
5175
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005176static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) {
5177 EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl();
5178
5179 // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size.
5180 if (!Enum->isFixed())
5181 return 'i';
5182
5183 // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005184 const BuiltinType *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5185 return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(C, BT->getKind());
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005186}
5187
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005188static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S,
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005189 QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) {
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005190 assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl");
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005191 S += 'b';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005192 // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits.
5193 // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b,
5194 // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the
5195 // bitfield, then the size in bits. For example, in this structure:
5196 //
5197 // struct
5198 // {
5199 // int integer;
5200 // int flags:2;
5201 // };
5202 // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT
5203 // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime. The reason for this extra
5204 // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for
5205 // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that
5206 // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes...
John McCall5fb5df92012-06-20 06:18:46 +00005207 if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005208 const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent();
5209 const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD);
Eli Friedmana3c122d2011-07-07 01:54:01 +00005210 S += llvm::utostr(RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex()));
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005211 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
5212 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005213 else {
5214 const BuiltinType *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5215 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(Ctx, BT->getKind());
5216 }
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005217 }
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005218 S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx));
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005219}
5220
Daniel Dunbar07d07852009-10-18 21:17:35 +00005221// FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string.
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005222void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string& S,
5223 bool ExpandPointedToStructures,
5224 bool ExpandStructures,
Daniel Dunbarc040ce42009-04-20 06:37:24 +00005225 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005226 bool OutermostType,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005227 bool EncodingProperty,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005228 bool StructField,
5229 bool EncodeBlockParameters,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005230 bool EncodeClassNames,
5231 bool EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) const {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005232 CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T);
5233 switch (CT->getTypeClass()) {
5234 case Type::Builtin:
5235 case Type::Enum:
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005236 if (FD && FD->isBitField())
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005237 return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005238 if (const BuiltinType *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT))
5239 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(this, BT->getKind());
5240 else
5241 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT));
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005242 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005243
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005244 case Type::Complex: {
5245 const ComplexType *CT = T->castAs<ComplexType>();
Anders Carlsson39b2e132009-04-09 21:55:45 +00005246 S += 'j';
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005247 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(CT->getElementType(), S, false, false, nullptr,
5248 false, false);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005249 return;
5250 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005251
5252 case Type::Atomic: {
5253 const AtomicType *AT = T->castAs<AtomicType>();
5254 S += 'A';
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005255 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getValueType(), S, false, false, nullptr,
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005256 false, false);
5257 return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ffd7062010-04-13 23:45:47 +00005258 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005259
5260 // encoding for pointer or reference types.
5261 case Type::Pointer:
5262 case Type::LValueReference:
5263 case Type::RValueReference: {
5264 QualType PointeeTy;
5265 if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) {
5266 const PointerType *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>();
5267 if (PT->isObjCSelType()) {
5268 S += ':';
5269 return;
5270 }
5271 PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
5272 } else {
5273 PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
5274 }
5275
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005276 bool isReadOnly = false;
5277 // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the
5278 // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'. The read-only qualifier of
5279 // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005280 // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type!
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005281 if (isa<TypedefType>(T.getTypePtr())) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005282 if (OutermostType && T.isConstQualified()) {
5283 isReadOnly = true;
5284 S += 'r';
5285 }
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00005286 } else if (OutermostType) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005287 QualType P = PointeeTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005288 while (P->getAs<PointerType>())
5289 P = P->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005290 if (P.isConstQualified()) {
5291 isReadOnly = true;
5292 S += 'r';
5293 }
5294 }
5295 if (isReadOnly) {
5296 // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type
5297 // combinations need to be rearranged.
5298 // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn"
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00005299 if (StringRef(S).endswith("nr"))
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00005300 S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn");
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005301 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005302
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005303 if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) {
5304 // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a
5305 // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'.
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005306 if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) {
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005307 S += '*';
5308 return;
5309 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005310 } else if (const RecordType *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Steve Naroff3de6b702009-07-22 17:14:51 +00005311 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#".
5312 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) {
5313 S += '#';
5314 return;
5315 }
5316 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@".
5317 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) {
5318 S += '@';
5319 return;
5320 }
5321 // fall through...
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005322 }
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005323 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005324 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy);
5325
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005326 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005327 nullptr);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005328 return;
5329 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005330
5331 case Type::ConstantArray:
5332 case Type::IncompleteArray:
5333 case Type::VariableArray: {
5334 const ArrayType *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT);
5335
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005336 if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !StructField) {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005337 // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element.
5338 S += '^';
5339
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005340 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005341 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
5342 } else {
5343 S += '[';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005344
Fariborz Jahanianf0dc11a2013-06-04 16:04:37 +00005345 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5346 S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getSize().getZExtValue());
5347 else {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005348 //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005349 assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) &&
5350 "Unknown array type!");
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005351 S += '0';
5352 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005353
5354 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005355 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
5356 S += ']';
5357 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005358 return;
5359 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005360
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005361 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
5362 case Type::FunctionProto:
Anders Carlssondf4cc612007-10-30 00:06:20 +00005363 S += '?';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005364 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005365
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005366 case Type::Record: {
5367 RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl();
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005368 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{';
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005369 // Anonymous structures print as '?'
5370 if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) {
5371 S += II->getName();
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005372 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
5373 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) {
5374 const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Benjamin Kramer9170e912013-02-22 15:46:01 +00005375 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S);
5376 TemplateSpecializationType::PrintTemplateArgumentList(OS,
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00005377 TemplateArgs.data(),
5378 TemplateArgs.size(),
Douglas Gregorc0b07282011-09-27 22:38:19 +00005379 (*this).getPrintingPolicy());
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005380 }
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005381 } else {
5382 S += '?';
5383 }
Daniel Dunbarfc1066d2008-10-17 20:21:44 +00005384 if (ExpandStructures) {
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005385 S += '=';
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005386 if (!RDecl->isUnion()) {
5387 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD);
5388 } else {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00005389 for (const auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005390 if (FD) {
5391 S += '"';
5392 S += Field->getNameAsString();
5393 S += '"';
5394 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005395
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005396 // Special case bit-fields.
5397 if (Field->isBitField()) {
5398 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true,
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00005399 Field);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005400 } else {
5401 QualType qt = Field->getType();
5402 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5403 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true,
5404 FD, /*OutermostType*/false,
5405 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
5406 /*StructField*/true);
5407 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005408 }
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005409 }
Fariborz Jahanianbc92fd72007-11-13 23:21:38 +00005410 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005411 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005412 return;
5413 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005414
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005415 case Type::BlockPointer: {
5416 const BlockPointerType *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>();
Steve Naroff49140cb2009-02-02 18:24:29 +00005417 S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?".
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005418 if (EncodeBlockParameters) {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005419 const FunctionType *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005420
5421 S += '<';
5422 // Block return type
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005423 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5424 FT->getReturnType(), S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures,
5425 FD, false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
5426 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005427 // Block self
5428 S += "@?";
5429 // Block parameters
5430 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
Aaron Ballman40bd0aa2014-03-17 15:23:01 +00005431 for (const auto &I : FPT->param_types())
5432 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5433 I, S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures, FD,
5434 false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
5435 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005436 }
5437 S += '>';
5438 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005439 return;
5440 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005441
Fariborz Jahanian33fa9622014-01-28 20:41:15 +00005442 case Type::ObjCObject: {
5443 // hack to match legacy encoding of *id and *Class
5444 QualType Ty = getObjCObjectPointerType(CT);
5445 if (Ty->isObjCIdType()) {
5446 S += "{objc_object=}";
5447 return;
5448 }
5449 else if (Ty->isObjCClassType()) {
5450 S += "{objc_class=}";
5451 return;
5452 }
5453 }
5454
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005455 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
5456 // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level.
5457 T = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getBaseType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005458
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005459 // The assumption seems to be that this assert will succeed
5460 // because nested levels will have filtered out 'id' and 'Class'.
5461 const ObjCInterfaceType *OIT = T->castAs<ObjCInterfaceType>();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005462 // @encode(class_name)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005463 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OIT->getDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005464 S += '{';
5465 const IdentifierInfo *II = OI->getIdentifier();
5466 S += II->getName();
5467 S += '=';
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005468 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005469 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5470 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005471 const FieldDecl *Field = cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]);
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005472 if (Field->isBitField())
5473 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, Field);
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005474 else
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005475 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, FD,
5476 false, false, false, false, false,
5477 EncodePointerToObjCTypedef);
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005478 }
5479 S += '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005480 return;
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005481 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005482
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005483 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
5484 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005485 if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) {
5486 S += '@';
5487 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005488 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005489
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00005490 if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) {
5491 // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'.
5492 // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with runtime
5493 // folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obsure construct.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005494 S += '#';
5495 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005496 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005497
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005498 if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005499 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(getObjCIdType(), S,
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005500 ExpandPointedToStructures,
5501 ExpandStructures, FD);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005502 if (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005503 // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifer list
5504 // Only when doing ivar or property encoding.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005505 S += '"';
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005506 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005507 S += '<';
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005508 S += I->getNameAsString();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005509 S += '>';
5510 }
5511 S += '"';
5512 }
5513 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005514 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005515
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005516 QualType PointeeTy = OPT->getPointeeType();
5517 if (!EncodingProperty &&
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005518 isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr()) &&
5519 !EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005520 // Another historical/compatibility reason.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005521 // We encode the underlying type which comes out as
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005522 // {...};
5523 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005524 if (FD && OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc682ef52013-07-12 16:41:56 +00005525 // Prevent recursive encoding of fields in some rare cases.
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005526 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OPT->getInterfaceDecl();
5527 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
5528 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5529 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
5530 if (cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]) == FD) {
5531 S += '{';
5532 S += OI->getIdentifier()->getName();
5533 S += '}';
5534 return;
5535 }
5536 }
5537 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005538 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S,
5539 false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005540 nullptr,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005541 false, false, false, false, false,
5542 /*EncodePointerToObjCTypedef*/true);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005543 return;
5544 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005545
5546 S += '@';
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005547 if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() &&
5548 (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames)) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005549 S += '"';
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00005550 S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getIdentifier()->getName();
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005551 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005552 S += '<';
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005553 S += I->getNameAsString();
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005554 S += '>';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005555 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005556 S += '"';
5557 }
5558 return;
5559 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005560
John McCalla9e6e8d2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00005561 // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005562 // FIXME: we shoul do better than that. 'M' is available.
5563 case Type::MemberPointer:
John McCalla9e6e8d2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00005564 return;
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005565
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005566 case Type::Vector:
5567 case Type::ExtVector:
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005568 // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is
5569 // insufficient.
5570 // FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc.
5571 return;
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005572
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00005573 case Type::Auto:
5574 // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery.
5575 // Just ignore it.
5576 return;
5577
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005578#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5579#define TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5580#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5581 case Type::KIND:
5582#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5583 case Type::KIND:
5584#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5585 case Type::KIND:
5586#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
5587 llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!");
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005588 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005589 llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!");
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005590}
5591
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005592void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl,
5593 std::string &S,
5594 const FieldDecl *FD,
5595 bool includeVBases) const {
5596 assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl");
5597 assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions");
5598 if (!RDecl->getDefinition())
5599 return;
5600
5601 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl);
5602 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets;
5603 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl);
5604
5605 if (CXXRec) {
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +00005606 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->bases()) {
5607 if (!BI.isVirtual()) {
5608 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005609 if (base->isEmpty())
5610 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005611 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005612 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5613 std::make_pair(offs, base));
5614 }
5615 }
5616 }
5617
5618 unsigned i = 0;
5619 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator Field = RDecl->field_begin(),
5620 FieldEnd = RDecl->field_end();
5621 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field, ++i) {
5622 uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(i);
5623 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
David Blaikie40ed2972012-06-06 20:45:41 +00005624 std::make_pair(offs, *Field));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005625 }
5626
5627 if (CXXRec && includeVBases) {
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +00005628 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->vbases()) {
5629 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005630 if (base->isEmpty())
5631 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005632 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base));
Eli Friedman1d24af82013-09-18 01:59:16 +00005633 if (offs >= uint64_t(toBits(layout.getNonVirtualSize())) &&
5634 FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis81c0b5c2011-09-26 18:14:24 +00005635 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(),
5636 std::make_pair(offs, base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005637 }
5638 }
5639
5640 CharUnits size;
5641 if (CXXRec) {
5642 size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize();
5643 } else {
5644 size = layout.getSize();
5645 }
5646
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005647#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005648 uint64_t CurOffs = 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005649#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005650 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator
5651 CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin();
5652
Douglas Gregorf5d6c742012-04-27 22:30:01 +00005653 if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() &&
5654 (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005655 if (FD) {
5656 S += "\"_vptr$";
5657 std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString();
5658 if (recname.empty()) recname = "?";
5659 S += recname;
5660 S += '"';
5661 }
5662 S += "^^?";
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005663#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005664 CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005665#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005666 }
5667
5668 if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
5669 // Mark the end of the structure.
5670 uint64_t offs = toBits(size);
5671 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005672 std::make_pair(offs, nullptr));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005673 }
5674
5675 for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) {
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005676#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005677 assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005678 if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) {
5679 uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs;
5680 // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that
5681 // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case
5682 // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout.
5683 // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without
5684 // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the
5685 // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be
5686 // longer then though.
5687 CurOffs += padding;
5688 }
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005689#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005690
5691 NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005692 if (!dcl)
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005693 break; // reached end of structure.
5694
5695 if (CXXRecordDecl *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) {
5696 // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going
5697 // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which
5698 // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy,
5699 // making the encoding type bigger than it really is.
5700 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005701 assert(!base->isEmpty());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005702#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005703 CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005704#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005705 } else {
5706 FieldDecl *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl);
5707 if (FD) {
5708 S += '"';
5709 S += field->getNameAsString();
5710 S += '"';
5711 }
5712
5713 if (field->isBitField()) {
5714 EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005715#ifndef NDEBUG
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005716 CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005717#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005718 } else {
5719 QualType qt = field->getType();
5720 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5721 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, FD,
5722 /*OutermostType*/false,
5723 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
5724 /*StructField*/true);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005725#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005726 CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005727#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005728 }
5729 }
5730 }
5731}
5732
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005733void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
Fariborz Jahanianac73ff82007-11-01 17:18:37 +00005734 std::string& S) const {
5735 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In)
5736 S += 'n';
5737 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout)
5738 S += 'N';
5739 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out)
5740 S += 'o';
5741 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy)
5742 S += 'O';
5743 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref)
5744 S += 'R';
5745 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway)
5746 S += 'V';
5747}
5748
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005749TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const {
5750 if (!ObjCIdDecl) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005751 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, nullptr, 0);
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005752 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005753 ObjCIdDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "id");
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005754 }
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005755 return ObjCIdDecl;
Steve Naroff66e9f332007-10-15 14:41:52 +00005756}
5757
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00005758TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const {
5759 if (!ObjCSelDecl) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005760 QualType T = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy);
5761 ObjCSelDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "SEL");
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00005762 }
5763 return ObjCSelDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian4bef4622007-10-16 20:40:23 +00005764}
5765
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005766TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const {
5767 if (!ObjCClassDecl) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005768 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, nullptr, 0);
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005769 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005770 ObjCClassDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "Class");
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005771 }
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005772 return ObjCClassDecl;
Anders Carlssonf56a7ae2007-10-31 02:53:19 +00005773}
5774
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00005775ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const {
5776 if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) {
5777 ObjCProtocolClassDecl
5778 = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5779 SourceLocation(),
5780 &Idents.get("Protocol"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005781 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr,
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00005782 SourceLocation(), true);
5783 }
5784
5785 return ObjCProtocolClassDecl;
5786}
5787
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005788//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5789// __builtin_va_list Construction Functions
5790//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5791
5792static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5793 // typedef char* __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005794 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy);
5795 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005796}
5797
5798static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5799 // typedef void* __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005800 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5801 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005802}
5803
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005804static TypedefDecl *
5805CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005806 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005807 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005808 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5809 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
5810 NamespaceDecl *NS;
5811 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5812 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005813 /*Inline*/ false, SourceLocation(),
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005814 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005815 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005816 NS->setImplicit();
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005817 VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005818 }
5819
5820 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5821
5822 const size_t NumFields = 5;
5823 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5824 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5825
5826 // void *__stack;
5827 FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5828 FieldNames[0] = "__stack";
5829
5830 // void *__gr_top;
5831 FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5832 FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top";
5833
5834 // void *__vr_top;
5835 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5836 FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top";
5837
5838 // int __gr_offs;
5839 FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy;
5840 FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs";
5841
5842 // int __vr_offs;
5843 FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy;
5844 FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs";
5845
5846 // Create fields
5847 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5848 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5849 VaListTagDecl,
5850 SourceLocation(),
5851 SourceLocation(),
5852 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005853 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5854 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005855 /*Mutable=*/false,
5856 ICIS_NoInit);
5857 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5858 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5859 }
5860 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5861 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
5862 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
5863
5864 // } __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005865 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__builtin_va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005866}
5867
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005868static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5869 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
5870 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
5871
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005872 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005873 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5874
5875 const size_t NumFields = 5;
5876 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5877 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5878
5879 // unsigned char gpr;
5880 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
5881 FieldNames[0] = "gpr";
5882
5883 // unsigned char fpr;
5884 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
5885 FieldNames[1] = "fpr";
5886
5887 // unsigned short reserved;
5888 FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy;
5889 FieldNames[2] = "reserved";
5890
5891 // void* overflow_arg_area;
5892 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5893 FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area";
5894
5895 // void* reg_save_area;
5896 FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5897 FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area";
5898
5899 // Create fields
5900 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5901 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl,
5902 SourceLocation(),
5903 SourceLocation(),
5904 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005905 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5906 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005907 /*Mutable=*/false,
5908 ICIS_NoInit);
5909 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5910 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5911 }
5912 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5913 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00005914 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005915
5916 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005917 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
5918 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
5919
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005920 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
5921 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
5922
5923 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
5924 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
5925 QualType VaListTagArrayType
5926 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
5927 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005928 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005929}
5930
5931static TypedefDecl *
5932CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5933 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
5934 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005935 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005936 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5937
5938 const size_t NumFields = 4;
5939 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5940 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5941
5942 // unsigned gp_offset;
5943 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
5944 FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset";
5945
5946 // unsigned fp_offset;
5947 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
5948 FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset";
5949
5950 // void* overflow_arg_area;
5951 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5952 FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area";
5953
5954 // void* reg_save_area;
5955 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5956 FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area";
5957
5958 // Create fields
5959 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5960 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5961 VaListTagDecl,
5962 SourceLocation(),
5963 SourceLocation(),
5964 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005965 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5966 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005967 /*Mutable=*/false,
5968 ICIS_NoInit);
5969 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5970 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5971 }
5972 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5973 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00005974 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005975
5976 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005977 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
5978 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
5979
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005980 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
5981 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
5982
5983 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
5984 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
5985 QualType VaListTagArrayType
5986 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
5987 Size, ArrayType::Normal,0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005988 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005989}
5990
5991static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5992 // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4];
5993 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4);
5994 QualType IntArrayType
5995 = Context->getConstantArrayType(Context->IntTy,
5996 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005997 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(IntArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005998}
5999
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006000static TypedefDecl *
6001CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006002 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006003 RecordDecl *VaListDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006004 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6005 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
6006 NamespaceDecl *NS;
6007 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6008 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6009 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
6010 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006011 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006012 NS->setImplicit();
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006013 VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006014 }
6015
6016 VaListDecl->startDefinition();
6017
6018 // void * __ap;
6019 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6020 VaListDecl,
6021 SourceLocation(),
6022 SourceLocation(),
6023 &Context->Idents.get("__ap"),
6024 Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006025 /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6026 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006027 /*Mutable=*/false,
6028 ICIS_NoInit);
6029 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6030 VaListDecl->addDecl(Field);
6031
6032 // };
6033 VaListDecl->completeDefinition();
6034
6035 // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006036 QualType T = Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl);
6037 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006038}
6039
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006040static TypedefDecl *
6041CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6042 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6043 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006044 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006045 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6046
6047 const size_t NumFields = 4;
6048 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6049 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6050
6051 // long __gpr;
6052 FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy;
6053 FieldNames[0] = "__gpr";
6054
6055 // long __fpr;
6056 FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy;
6057 FieldNames[1] = "__fpr";
6058
6059 // void *__overflow_arg_area;
6060 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6061 FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area";
6062
6063 // void *__reg_save_area;
6064 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6065 FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area";
6066
6067 // Create fields
6068 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6069 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6070 VaListTagDecl,
6071 SourceLocation(),
6072 SourceLocation(),
6073 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006074 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6075 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006076 /*Mutable=*/false,
6077 ICIS_NoInit);
6078 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6079 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6080 }
6081 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6082 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6083 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
6084
6085 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006086 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
6087 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006088 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6089 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6090
6091 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6092 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6093 QualType VaListTagArrayType
6094 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6095 Size, ArrayType::Normal,0);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006096
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006097 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006098}
6099
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006100static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6101 TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) {
6102 switch (Kind) {
6103 case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList:
6104 return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6105 case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList:
6106 return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006107 case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6108 return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006109 case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList:
6110 return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6111 case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6112 return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6113 case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList:
6114 return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006115 case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList:
6116 return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006117 case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList:
6118 return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006119 }
6120
6121 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind");
6122}
6123
6124TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006125 if (!BuiltinVaListDecl) {
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006126 BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind());
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006127 assert(BuiltinVaListDecl->isImplicit());
6128 }
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006129
6130 return BuiltinVaListDecl;
6131}
6132
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006133QualType ASTContext::getVaListTagType() const {
6134 // Force the creation of VaListTagTy by building the __builtin_va_list
6135 // declaration.
6136 if (VaListTagTy.isNull())
6137 (void) getBuiltinVaListDecl();
6138
6139 return VaListTagTy;
6140}
6141
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006142void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006143 assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() &&
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006144 "'NSConstantString' type already set!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006145
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006146 ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006147}
6148
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006149/// \brief Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty
6150/// lookup.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006151TemplateName
6152ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
6153 UnresolvedSetIterator End) const {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006154 unsigned size = End - Begin;
6155 assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!");
6156
6157 void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) +
6158 size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*));
6159 OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = new(memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size);
6160
6161 NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00006162 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006163 NamedDecl *D = *I;
6164 assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) ||
6165 (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) &&
6166 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl())));
6167 *Storage++ = D;
6168 }
6169
6170 return TemplateName(OT);
6171}
6172
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006173/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified
6174/// template name such as \c std::vector.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006175TemplateName
6176ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6177 bool TemplateKeyword,
6178 TemplateDecl *Template) const {
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00006179 assert(NNS && "Missing nested-name-specifier in qualified template name");
6180
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006181 // FIXME: Canonicalization?
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006182 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6183 QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
6184
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006185 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006186 QualifiedTemplateName *QTN =
6187 QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6188 if (!QTN) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006189 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<QualifiedTemplateName>())
6190 QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006191 QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6192 }
6193
6194 return TemplateName(QTN);
6195}
6196
6197/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6198/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006199TemplateName
6200ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6201 const IdentifierInfo *Name) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006202 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor308047d2009-09-09 00:23:06 +00006203 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006204
6205 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6206 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name);
6207
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006208 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006209 DependentTemplateName *QTN =
6210 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6211
6212 if (QTN)
6213 return TemplateName(QTN);
6214
6215 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6216 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006217 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6218 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006219 } else {
6220 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name);
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006221 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6222 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006223 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN =
6224 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6225 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken");
6226 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006227 }
6228
6229 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6230 return TemplateName(QTN);
6231}
6232
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006233/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6234/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+.
6235TemplateName
6236ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006237 OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const {
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006238 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
6239 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
6240
6241 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6242 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006243
6244 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006245 DependentTemplateName *QTN
6246 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006247
6248 if (QTN)
6249 return TemplateName(QTN);
6250
6251 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6252 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006253 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6254 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006255 } else {
6256 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator);
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006257 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6258 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006259
6260 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN
6261 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6262 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken");
6263 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006264 }
6265
6266 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6267 return TemplateName(QTN);
6268}
6269
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006270TemplateName
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006271ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *param,
6272 TemplateName replacement) const {
6273 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6274 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, param, replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006275
6276 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006277 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
6278 = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
6279
6280 if (!subst) {
6281 subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(param, replacement);
6282 SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos);
6283 }
6284
6285 return TemplateName(subst);
6286}
6287
6288TemplateName
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006289ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param,
6290 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) const {
6291 ASTContext &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this);
6292 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6293 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, Param, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006294
6295 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006296 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst
6297 = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6298
6299 if (!Subst) {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006300 Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(Param,
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006301 ArgPack.pack_size(),
6302 ArgPack.pack_begin());
6303 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos);
6304 }
6305
6306 return TemplateName(Subst);
6307}
6308
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006309/// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by
Douglas Gregorab138572008-11-03 15:57:00 +00006310/// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type
6311/// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType.
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006312CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const {
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006313 switch (Type) {
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006314 case TargetInfo::NoInt: return CanQualType();
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00006315 case TargetInfo::SignedChar: return SignedCharTy;
6316 case TargetInfo::UnsignedChar: return UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006317 case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy;
6318 case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy;
6319 case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy;
6320 case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy;
6321 case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy;
6322 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy;
6323 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy;
6324 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy;
6325 }
6326
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00006327 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value");
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006328}
Ted Kremenek77c51b22008-07-24 23:58:27 +00006329
6330//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6331// Type Predicates.
6332//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6333
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006334/// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's
6335/// garbage collection attribute.
6336///
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006337Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006338 if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC)
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006339 return Qualifiers::GCNone;
6340
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006341 assert(getLangOpts().ObjC1);
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006342 Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr();
6343
6344 // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers
6345 // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared
6346 // as __strong.
6347 if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) {
6348 if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
6349 return Qualifiers::Strong;
6350 else if (Ty->isPointerType())
6351 return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
6352 } else {
6353 // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a
6354 // pointer.
6355#ifndef NDEBUG
6356 QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal();
6357 while (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT))
6358 CT = AT->getElementType();
6359 assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType());
6360#endif
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006361 }
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00006362 return GCAttrs;
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006363}
6364
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006365//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6366// Type Compatibility Testing
6367//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattnerb338a6b2007-11-01 05:03:41 +00006368
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006369/// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006370/// compatible.
6371static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS,
6372 const VectorType *RHS) {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00006373 assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006374 return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006375 LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006376}
6377
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006378bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,
6379 QualType SecondVec) {
6380 assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type");
6381 assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type");
6382
6383 if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec))
6384 return true;
6385
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006386 // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the
6387 // equivalent GCC vector types.
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006388 const VectorType *First = FirstVec->getAs<VectorType>();
6389 const VectorType *Second = SecondVec->getAs<VectorType>();
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006390 if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() &&
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006391 hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) &&
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006392 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6393 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
6394 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6395 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool)
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006396 return true;
6397
6398 return false;
6399}
6400
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006401//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6402// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's.
6403//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6404
6405/// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the
6406/// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006407bool
6408ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto,
6409 ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00006410 if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006411 return true;
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00006412 for (auto *PI : rProto->protocols())
6413 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, PI))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006414 return true;
6415 return false;
6416}
6417
Dmitri Gribenko4364fcf2012-08-28 02:49:14 +00006418/// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare Class<pr,...> and
6419/// Class<pr1, ...>.
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006420bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs,
6421 QualType rhs) {
6422 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6423 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6424 assert ((lhsQID && rhsOPT) && "ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible");
6425
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006426 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006427 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006428 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006429 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) {
6430 match = true;
6431 break;
6432 }
6433 }
6434 if (!match)
6435 return false;
6436 }
6437 return true;
6438}
6439
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006440/// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an
6441/// ObjCQualifiedIDType.
6442bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6443 bool compare) {
6444 // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' or void* type in all cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006445 if (lhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006446 lhs->isObjCIdType() || lhs->isObjCClassType())
6447 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006448 else if (rhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006449 rhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCClassType())
6450 return true;
6451
6452 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006453 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006454
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006455 if (!rhsOPT) return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006456
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006457 if (rhsOPT->qual_empty()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006458 // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006459 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6460 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006461 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006462 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6463 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6464 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006465 if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006466 return false;
6467 }
6468 }
6469 // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'.
6470 return true;
6471 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006472 // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006473 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006474 bool match = false;
6475
6476 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6477 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6478 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006479 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006480 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6481 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6482 match = true;
6483 break;
6484 }
6485 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006486 // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006487 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6488 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006489 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006490 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6491 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6492 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006493 if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true)) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006494 match = true;
6495 break;
6496 }
6497 }
6498 }
6499 if (!match)
6500 return false;
6501 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006502
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006503 return true;
6504 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006505
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006506 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsQID = rhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType();
6507 assert(rhsQID && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>");
6508
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006509 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT =
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006510 lhs->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006511 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006512 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006513 bool match = false;
6514
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006515 // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006516 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6517 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006518 // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct
6519 // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006520 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006521 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6522 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6523 match = true;
6524 break;
6525 }
6526 }
6527 if (!match)
6528 return false;
6529 }
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006530
6531 // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols
6532 // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
6533 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6534 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
6535 CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols);
6536 // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has
6537 // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s)
6538 // assume that it is mismatch.
6539 if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhsOPT->qual_empty())
6540 return false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006541 for (auto *lhsProto : LHSInheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006542 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006543 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006544 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6545 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6546 match = true;
6547 break;
6548 }
6549 }
6550 if (!match)
6551 return false;
6552 }
6553 }
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006554 return true;
6555 }
6556 return false;
6557}
6558
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006559/// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006560/// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS. This handles validation of any
6561/// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS.
6562///
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006563bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6564 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006565 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6566 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6567
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00006568 // If either type represents the built-in 'id' or 'Class' types, return true.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006569 if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() ||
6570 RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006571 return true;
6572
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006573 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006574 return ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6575 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006576 false);
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006577
6578 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass())
6579 return ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6580 QualType(RHSOPT,0));
6581
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006582 // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path.
6583 if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface())
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006584 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006585
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006586 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006587}
6588
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006589/// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written
Chris Lattner57540c52011-04-15 05:22:18 +00006590/// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006591/// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where
6592/// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is
6593/// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK.
6594bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
6595 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006596 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
6597 bool BlockReturnType) {
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00006598 if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006599 return true;
6600
6601 if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
6602 return RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType();
6603 }
6604
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00006605 if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006606 return ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6607 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
6608 false);
6609
6610 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6611 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6612 if (LHS && RHS) { // We have 2 user-defined types.
6613 if (LHS != RHS) {
6614 if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl()))
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006615 return BlockReturnType;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006616 if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl()))
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006617 return !BlockReturnType;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006618 }
6619 else
6620 return true;
6621 }
6622 return false;
6623}
6624
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006625/// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set
6626/// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects.
6627/// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of
6628/// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects.
6629static
6630void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context,
6631 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6632 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006633 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionOfProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006634
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006635 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6636 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6637 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base");
6638 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base");
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006639
6640 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocolSet;
6641 unsigned LHSNumProtocols = LHS->getNumProtocols();
6642 if (LHSNumProtocols > 0)
6643 InheritedProtocolSet.insert(LHS->qual_begin(), LHS->qual_end());
6644 else {
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006645 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006646 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(),
6647 LHSInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006648 InheritedProtocolSet.insert(LHSInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6649 LHSInheritedProtocols.end());
6650 }
6651
6652 unsigned RHSNumProtocols = RHS->getNumProtocols();
6653 if (RHSNumProtocols > 0) {
Dan Gohman145f3f12010-04-19 16:39:44 +00006654 ObjCProtocolDecl **RHSProtocols =
6655 const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl **>(RHS->qual_begin());
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006656 for (unsigned i = 0; i < RHSNumProtocols; ++i)
6657 if (InheritedProtocolSet.count(RHSProtocols[i]))
6658 IntersectionOfProtocols.push_back(RHSProtocols[i]);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00006659 } else {
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006660 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSInheritedProtocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006661 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(),
6662 RHSInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006663 for (llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*,8>::iterator I =
6664 RHSInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6665 E = RHSInheritedProtocols.end(); I != E; ++I)
6666 if (InheritedProtocolSet.count((*I)))
6667 IntersectionOfProtocols.push_back((*I));
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006668 }
6669}
6670
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006671/// areCommonBaseCompatible - Returns common base class of the two classes if
6672/// one found. Note that this is O'2 algorithm. But it will be called as the
6673/// last type comparison in a ?-exp of ObjC pointer types before a
6674/// warning is issued. So, its invokation is extremely rare.
6675QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible(
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006676 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr,
6677 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) {
6678 const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType();
6679 const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType();
6680 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface();
6681 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface();
Douglas Gregor0b144e12011-12-15 00:29:59 +00006682 if (!LDecl || !RDecl || (declaresSameEntity(LDecl, RDecl)))
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006683 return QualType();
6684
Fariborz Jahanianb1071432011-04-18 21:16:59 +00006685 do {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006686 LHS = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(getObjCInterfaceType(LDecl));
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006687 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS)) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006688 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006689 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, Lptr, Rptr, Protocols);
6690
6691 QualType Result = QualType(LHS, 0);
6692 if (!Protocols.empty())
6693 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, Protocols.data(), Protocols.size());
6694 Result = getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
6695 return Result;
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006696 }
Fariborz Jahanianb1071432011-04-18 21:16:59 +00006697 } while ((LDecl = LDecl->getSuperClass()));
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006698
6699 return QualType();
6700}
6701
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006702bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS,
6703 const ObjCObjectType *RHS) {
6704 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type");
6705 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type");
6706
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006707 // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of
6708 // the LHS.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006709 if (!LHS->getInterface()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface()))
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006710 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006711
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006712 // RHS must have a superset of the protocols in the LHS. If the LHS is not
6713 // protocol qualified at all, then we are good.
Steve Naroffc277ad12009-07-18 15:33:26 +00006714 if (LHS->getNumProtocols() == 0)
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006715 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006716
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006717 // Okay, we know the LHS has protocol qualifiers. If the RHS doesn't,
6718 // more detailed analysis is required.
6719 if (RHS->getNumProtocols() == 0) {
6720 // OK, if LHS is a superclass of RHS *and*
6721 // this superclass is assignment compatible with LHS.
6722 // false otherwise.
Fariborz Jahanian240400b2011-04-12 16:34:14 +00006723 bool IsSuperClass =
6724 LHS->getInterface()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface());
6725 if (IsSuperClass) {
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006726 // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types
6727 // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols
6728 // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok.
6729 // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>.
6730 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols;
Fariborz Jahanian240400b2011-04-12 16:34:14 +00006731 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006732 // If super class has no protocols, it is not a match.
6733 if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty())
6734 return false;
6735
Aaron Ballman1683f7b2014-03-17 15:55:30 +00006736 for (const auto *LHSProto : LHS->quals()) {
6737 bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false;
6738 for (auto *SuperClassProto : SuperClassInheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006739 if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) {
6740 SuperImplementsProtocol = true;
6741 break;
6742 }
6743 }
6744 if (!SuperImplementsProtocol)
6745 return false;
6746 }
6747 return true;
6748 }
6749 return false;
6750 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006751
Aaron Ballman1683f7b2014-03-17 15:55:30 +00006752 for (const auto *LHSPI : LHS->quals()) {
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006753 bool RHSImplementsProtocol = false;
6754
6755 // If the RHS doesn't implement the protocol on the left, the types
6756 // are incompatible.
Aaron Ballman1683f7b2014-03-17 15:55:30 +00006757 for (auto *RHSPI : RHS->quals()) {
6758 if (RHSPI->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSPI->getIdentifier())) {
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006759 RHSImplementsProtocol = true;
Steve Narofffac5bc92009-07-16 16:21:02 +00006760 break;
6761 }
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006762 }
6763 // FIXME: For better diagnostics, consider passing back the protocol name.
6764 if (!RHSImplementsProtocol)
6765 return false;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006766 }
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006767 // The RHS implements all protocols listed on the LHS.
6768 return true;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006769}
6770
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006771bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
6772 // get the "pointed to" types
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006773 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6774 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006775
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006776 if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT)
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006777 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006778
6779 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) ||
6780 canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT);
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006781}
6782
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00006783bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) {
6784 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(
6785 getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
6786 getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>());
6787}
6788
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006789/// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible,
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00006790/// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006791/// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00006792/// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules.
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006793bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
6794 bool CompareUnqualified) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006795 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00006796 return hasSameType(LHS, RHS);
6797
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006798 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006799}
6800
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00006801bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
Fariborz Jahanianc87c8792011-07-12 23:20:13 +00006802 return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00006803}
6804
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006805bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
6806 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull();
6807}
6808
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006809/// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member
6810/// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return
6811/// QualType()
6812QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType,
6813 bool OfBlockPointer,
6814 bool Unqualified) {
6815 if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) {
6816 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
6817 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00006818 for (const auto *I : UD->fields()) {
6819 QualType ET = I->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006820 QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6821 if (!MT.isNull())
6822 return MT;
6823 }
6824 }
6825 }
6826
6827 return QualType();
6828}
6829
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00006830/// mergeFunctionParameterTypes - merge two types which appear as function
6831/// parameter types
6832QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionParameterTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6833 bool OfBlockPointer,
6834 bool Unqualified) {
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006835 // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function
6836 // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other
6837 // type is compatible with a union member
6838 QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer,
6839 Unqualified);
6840 if (!lmerge.isNull())
6841 return lmerge;
6842
6843 QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer,
6844 Unqualified);
6845 if (!rmerge.isNull())
6846 return rmerge;
6847
6848 return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6849}
6850
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006851QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006852 bool OfBlockPointer,
6853 bool Unqualified) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006854 const FunctionType *lbase = lhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
6855 const FunctionType *rbase = rhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00006856 const FunctionProtoType *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase);
6857 const FunctionProtoType *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006858 bool allLTypes = true;
6859 bool allRTypes = true;
6860
6861 // Check return type
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006862 QualType retType;
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00006863 if (OfBlockPointer) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006864 QualType RHS = rbase->getReturnType();
6865 QualType LHS = lbase->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00006866 bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified;
6867 if (!UnqualifiedResult)
6868 UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers());
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006869 retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true);
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00006870 }
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006871 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006872 retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getReturnType(), rbase->getReturnType(), false,
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006873 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006874 if (retType.isNull()) return QualType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006875
6876 if (Unqualified)
6877 retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType();
6878
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006879 CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getReturnType());
6880 CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getReturnType());
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006881 if (Unqualified) {
6882 LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
6883 RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
6884 }
6885
6886 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006887 allLTypes = false;
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006888 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006889 allRTypes = false;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006890
Daniel Dunbaredd5bae2010-04-28 16:20:58 +00006891 // FIXME: double check this
6892 // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
6893 // rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
6894 // lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()?
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00006895 FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo();
6896 FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006897
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00006898 // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00006899 if (lbaseInfo.getCC() != rbaseInfo.getCC())
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00006900 return QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006901
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006902 // Regparm is part of the calling convention.
Eli Friedmanc5b20b52011-04-09 08:18:08 +00006903 if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm())
6904 return QualType();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006905 if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm())
6906 return QualType();
6907
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006908 if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult())
6909 return QualType();
6910
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006911 // FIXME: some uses, e.g. conditional exprs, really want this to be 'both'.
6912 bool NoReturn = lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006913
Rafael Espindola8778c282012-11-29 16:09:03 +00006914 if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
6915 allLTypes = false;
6916 if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
6917 allRTypes = false;
6918
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006919 FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn);
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00006920
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006921 if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00006922 assert(!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec() &&
6923 "C++ shouldn't be here");
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006924 // Compatible functions must have the same number of parameters
6925 if (lproto->getNumParams() != rproto->getNumParams())
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006926 return QualType();
6927
6928 // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible
6929 if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic())
6930 return QualType();
6931
Argyrios Kyrtzidis22a37352008-10-26 16:43:14 +00006932 if (lproto->getTypeQuals() != rproto->getTypeQuals())
6933 return QualType();
6934
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00006935 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
6936 !FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(rproto, lproto))
6937 return QualType();
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006938
6939 // Check parameter type compatibility
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006940 SmallVector<QualType, 10> types;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006941 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lproto->getNumParams(); i < n; i++) {
6942 QualType lParamType = lproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
6943 QualType rParamType = rproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
6944 QualType paramType = mergeFunctionParameterTypes(
6945 lParamType, rParamType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6946 if (paramType.isNull())
6947 return QualType();
6948
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006949 if (Unqualified)
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006950 paramType = paramType.getUnqualifiedType();
6951
6952 types.push_back(paramType);
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006953 if (Unqualified) {
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006954 lParamType = lParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
6955 rParamType = rParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006956 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006957
6958 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(lParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006959 allLTypes = false;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006960 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(rParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006961 allRTypes = false;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006962 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00006963
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006964 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
6965 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00006966
6967 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo();
6968 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00006969 return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006970 }
6971
6972 if (lproto) allRTypes = false;
6973 if (rproto) allLTypes = false;
6974
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00006975 const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006976 if (proto) {
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00006977 assert(!proto->hasExceptionSpec() && "C++ shouldn't be here");
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006978 if (proto->isVariadic()) return QualType();
6979 // Check that the types are compatible with the types that
6980 // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15).
6981 // The only types actually affected are promotable integer
6982 // types and floats, which would be passed as a different
6983 // type depending on whether the prototype is visible.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006984 for (unsigned i = 0, n = proto->getNumParams(); i < n; ++i) {
6985 QualType paramTy = proto->getParamType(i);
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00006986
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00006987 // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used
Douglas Gregor2973d402010-02-03 19:27:29 +00006988 // to pass enum values.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006989 if (const EnumType *Enum = paramTy->getAs<EnumType>()) {
6990 paramTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
6991 if (paramTy.isNull())
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00006992 return QualType();
6993 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006994
6995 if (paramTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ||
6996 getCanonicalType(paramTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy)
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006997 return QualType();
6998 }
6999
7000 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7001 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007002
7003 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo();
7004 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007005 return getFunctionType(retType, proto->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007006 }
7007
7008 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7009 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007010 return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007011}
7012
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007013/// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them.
7014static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET,
7015 QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) {
7016 // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char,
7017 // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type.
7018 // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion
7019 // type.
7020 QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7021 if (underlyingType.isNull()) return QualType();
7022 if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other))
7023 return other;
7024
7025 // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any
7026 // integral type of the same size.
7027 if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() &&
7028 Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other))
7029 return other;
7030
7031 return QualType();
7032}
7033
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007034QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007035 bool OfBlockPointer,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007036 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType) {
Bill Wendlingdb4e3492007-12-03 07:33:35 +00007037 // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the
7038 // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression
7039 // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007040 // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and
7041 // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses).
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007042 assert(!LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "LHS is a reference type?");
7043 assert(!RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "RHS is a reference type?");
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007044
7045 if (Unqualified) {
7046 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7047 RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7048 }
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007049
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007050 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7051 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7052
7053 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7054 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7055 return LHS;
7056
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007057 // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00007058 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7059 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007060 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7061 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type
7062 // mismatch.
7063 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007064 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() ||
7065 LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime())
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007066 return QualType();
7067
7068 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7069 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7070 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7071 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7072 // qualified __strong.
7073 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7074 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7075 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7076
7077 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7078 return QualType();
7079
7080 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7081 return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong));
7082 }
7083 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7084 return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS);
7085 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007086 return QualType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007087 }
7088
7089 // Okay, qualifiers are equal.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007090
Eli Friedmandcca6332009-06-01 01:22:52 +00007091 Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass();
7092 Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007093
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007094 // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these
7095 // comparisons, just force one to the other.
7096 if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
7097 if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
Eli Friedman16f90962008-02-12 08:23:06 +00007098
7099 // Same as above for arrays
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007100 if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7101 LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
7102 if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7103 RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007104
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007105 // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects.
7106 if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7107 if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7108
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00007109 // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector.
7110 if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector;
7111 if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007112
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007113 // If the canonical type classes don't match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007114 if (LHSClass != RHSClass) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007115 // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum
7116 // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007117 if (const EnumType* ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007118 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007119 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007120 if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007121 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007122 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007123 // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type.
Fariborz Jahanian194904e2012-01-26 17:08:50 +00007124 if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) {
7125 if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType())
7126 return LHS;
7127 if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType())
7128 return RHS;
7129 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007130
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007131 return QualType();
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007132 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007133
Steve Naroffc6edcbd2008-01-09 22:43:08 +00007134 // The canonical type classes match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007135 switch (LHSClass) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007136#define TYPE(Class, Base)
7137#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
John McCallbd8d9bd2010-03-01 23:49:17 +00007138#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007139#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7140#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7141#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007142 llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007143
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00007144 case Type::Auto:
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007145 case Type::LValueReference:
7146 case Type::RValueReference:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007147 case Type::MemberPointer:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007148 llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007149
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007150 case Type::ObjCInterface:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007151 case Type::IncompleteArray:
7152 case Type::VariableArray:
7153 case Type::FunctionProto:
7154 case Type::ExtVector:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007155 llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007156
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007157 case Type::Pointer:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007158 {
7159 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007160 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7161 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007162 if (Unqualified) {
7163 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7164 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7165 }
7166 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false,
7167 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007168 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007169 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007170 return LHS;
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007171 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007172 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007173 return getPointerType(ResultType);
7174 }
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007175 case Type::BlockPointer:
7176 {
7177 // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007178 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7179 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007180 if (Unqualified) {
7181 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7182 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7183 }
7184 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer,
7185 Unqualified);
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007186 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7187 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7188 return LHS;
7189 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7190 return RHS;
7191 return getBlockPointerType(ResultType);
7192 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00007193 case Type::Atomic:
7194 {
7195 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
7196 QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7197 QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7198 if (Unqualified) {
7199 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7200 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7201 }
7202 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
7203 Unqualified);
7204 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7205 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7206 return LHS;
7207 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7208 return RHS;
7209 return getAtomicType(ResultType);
7210 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007211 case Type::ConstantArray:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007212 {
7213 const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS);
7214 const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS);
7215 if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getSize() != LCAT->getSize())
7216 return QualType();
7217
7218 QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType();
7219 QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007220 if (Unqualified) {
7221 LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7222 RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7223 }
7224
7225 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007226 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007227 if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7228 return LHS;
7229 if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7230 return RHS;
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007231 if (LCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(),
7232 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
7233 if (RCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(),
7234 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007235 const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS);
7236 const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS);
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007237 if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7238 return LHS;
7239 if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7240 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007241 if (LVAT) {
7242 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7243 // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type
7244 // has to be different.
7245 return LHS;
7246 }
7247 if (RVAT) {
7248 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7249 // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type
7250 // has to be different.
7251 return RHS;
7252 }
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007253 if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS;
7254 if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS;
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00007255 return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType,
7256 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007257 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007258 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007259 return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007260 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007261 case Type::Enum:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007262 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007263 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007264 // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007265 return QualType();
Daniel Dunbar804c0442009-01-28 21:22:12 +00007266 case Type::Complex:
7267 // Distinct complex types are incompatible.
7268 return QualType();
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007269 case Type::Vector:
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007270 // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector!
John McCall44c064b2010-03-12 23:14:13 +00007271 if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->getAs<VectorType>(),
7272 RHSCan->getAs<VectorType>()))
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007273 return LHS;
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007274 return QualType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007275 case Type::ObjCObject: {
7276 // Check if the types are assignment compatible.
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007277 // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether
7278 // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007279 const ObjCObjectType* LHSIface = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7280 const ObjCObjectType* RHSIface = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7281 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSIface, RHSIface))
Steve Naroff7a7814c2009-02-21 16:18:07 +00007282 return LHS;
7283
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007284 return QualType();
Cedric Venet4fc88b72009-02-21 17:14:49 +00007285 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007286 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007287 if (OfBlockPointer) {
7288 if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7289 LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007290 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7291 BlockReturnType))
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007292 return LHS;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007293 return QualType();
7294 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007295 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7296 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007297 return LHS;
7298
Steve Naroffc68cfcf2008-12-10 22:14:21 +00007299 return QualType();
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007300 }
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007301 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007302
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007303 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!");
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007304}
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00007305
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007306bool ASTContext::FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(
7307 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType,
7308 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType) {
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007309 if (FromFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedParams() !=
7310 ToFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedParams())
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007311 return false;
7312 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo FromEPI =
7313 FromFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
7314 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ToEPI =
7315 ToFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00007316 if (FromEPI.ConsumedParameters && ToEPI.ConsumedParameters)
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007317 for (unsigned i = 0, n = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); i != n; ++i) {
7318 if (FromEPI.ConsumedParameters[i] != ToEPI.ConsumedParameters[i])
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007319 return false;
7320 }
7321 return true;
7322}
7323
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007324/// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and
7325/// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function
7326/// return types.
7327QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7328 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7329 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7330 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7331 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7332 return LHS;
7333 if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) {
7334 if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType())
7335 return QualType();
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007336 QualType OldReturnType =
7337 cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007338 QualType NewReturnType =
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007339 cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007340 QualType ResReturnType =
7341 mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType);
7342 if (ResReturnType.isNull())
7343 return QualType();
7344 if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) {
7345 // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo();
7346 // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type.
7347 const FunctionType *F = LHS->getAs<FunctionType>();
7348 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) {
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007349 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
7350 EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS);
Reid Kleckner896b32f2013-06-10 20:51:09 +00007351 QualType ResultType =
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007352 getFunctionType(OldReturnType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007353 return ResultType;
7354 }
7355 }
7356 return QualType();
7357 }
7358
7359 // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged.
7360 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7361 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7362 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7363 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch.
7364 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
7365 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace())
7366 return QualType();
7367
7368 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7369 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7370 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7371 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7372 // qualified __strong.
7373 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7374 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7375 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7376
7377 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7378 return QualType();
7379
7380 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong)
7381 return LHS;
7382 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong)
7383 return RHS;
7384 return QualType();
7385 }
7386
7387 if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7388 QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7389 QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7390 QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT);
7391 if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT)
7392 return LHS;
7393 if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT)
7394 return RHS;
7395 }
7396 return QualType();
7397}
7398
Chris Lattner4ba0cef2008-04-07 07:01:58 +00007399//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007400// Integer Predicates
7401//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner3c919712009-01-16 07:15:35 +00007402
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007403unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const {
Richard Smithe9521062013-10-15 04:56:17 +00007404 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedmanee275c82009-12-10 22:29:29 +00007405 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00007406 if (T->isBooleanType())
7407 return 1;
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00007408 // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007409 return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T);
7410}
7411
Abramo Bagnara13640492012-09-09 10:21:24 +00007412QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00007413 assert(T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() && "Unexpected type");
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007414
7415 // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int>
7416 if (const VectorType *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
7417 return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00007418 VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007419
7420 // For enums, we return the unsigned version of the base type.
7421 if (const EnumType *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007422 T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007423
7424 const BuiltinType *BTy = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
7425 assert(BTy && "Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007426 switch (BTy->getKind()) {
7427 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
7428 case BuiltinType::SChar:
7429 return UnsignedCharTy;
7430 case BuiltinType::Short:
7431 return UnsignedShortTy;
7432 case BuiltinType::Int:
7433 return UnsignedIntTy;
7434 case BuiltinType::Long:
7435 return UnsignedLongTy;
7436 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
7437 return UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00007438 case BuiltinType::Int128:
7439 return UnsignedInt128Ty;
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007440 default:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007441 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007442 }
7443}
7444
Argyrios Kyrtzidis65ad5692010-10-24 17:26:36 +00007445ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() { }
7446
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00007447void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD,
7448 QualType ReturnType) {}
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007449
7450//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7451// Builtin Type Computation
7452//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7453
7454/// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007455/// pointer over the consumed characters. This returns the resultant type. If
7456/// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic
7457/// types. This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of
7458/// a vector of "i*".
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007459///
7460/// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required
7461/// to be an Integer Constant Expression.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007462static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007463 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007464 bool &RequiresICE,
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007465 bool AllowTypeModifiers) {
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007466 // Modifiers.
7467 int HowLong = 0;
7468 bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007469 RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007470
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007471 // Read the prefixed modifiers first.
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007472 bool Done = false;
7473 while (!Done) {
7474 switch (*Str++) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007475 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007476 case 'I':
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007477 RequiresICE = true;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007478 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007479 case 'S':
7480 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7481 assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
7482 Signed = true;
7483 break;
7484 case 'U':
7485 assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7486 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
7487 Unsigned = true;
7488 break;
7489 case 'L':
7490 assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier");
7491 ++HowLong;
7492 break;
Kevin Qinad64f6d2014-02-24 02:45:03 +00007493 case 'W':
7494 // This modifier represents int64 type.
7495 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'W' modifiers!");
7496 switch (Context.getTargetInfo().getInt64Type()) {
7497 default:
7498 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer type");
7499 case TargetInfo::SignedLong:
7500 HowLong = 1;
7501 break;
7502 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong:
7503 HowLong = 2;
7504 break;
7505 }
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007506 }
7507 }
7508
7509 QualType Type;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007510
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007511 // Read the base type.
7512 switch (*Str++) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007513 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007514 case 'v':
7515 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7516 "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!");
7517 Type = Context.VoidTy;
7518 break;
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00007519 case 'h':
7520 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7521 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
7522 Type = Context.HalfTy;
7523 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007524 case 'f':
7525 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7526 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
7527 Type = Context.FloatTy;
7528 break;
7529 case 'd':
7530 assert(HowLong < 2 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7531 "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!");
7532 if (HowLong)
7533 Type = Context.LongDoubleTy;
7534 else
7535 Type = Context.DoubleTy;
7536 break;
7537 case 's':
7538 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!");
7539 if (Unsigned)
7540 Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
7541 else
7542 Type = Context.ShortTy;
7543 break;
7544 case 'i':
7545 if (HowLong == 3)
7546 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty;
7547 else if (HowLong == 2)
7548 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
7549 else if (HowLong == 1)
7550 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
7551 else
7552 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
7553 break;
7554 case 'c':
7555 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!");
7556 if (Signed)
7557 Type = Context.SignedCharTy;
7558 else if (Unsigned)
7559 Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
7560 else
7561 Type = Context.CharTy;
7562 break;
7563 case 'b': // boolean
7564 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!");
7565 Type = Context.BoolTy;
7566 break;
7567 case 'z': // size_t.
7568 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!");
7569 Type = Context.getSizeType();
7570 break;
7571 case 'F':
7572 Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType();
7573 break;
Fariborz Jahaniand11da7e2010-11-09 21:38:20 +00007574 case 'G':
7575 Type = Context.getObjCIdType();
7576 break;
7577 case 'H':
7578 Type = Context.getObjCSelType();
7579 break;
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00007580 case 'M':
7581 Type = Context.getObjCSuperType();
7582 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007583 case 'a':
7584 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
7585 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
7586 break;
7587 case 'A':
7588 // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly
7589 // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two
7590 // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones
7591 // passed by reference. An example of a by-value va_list is
7592 // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list
7593 // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86,
7594 // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want
7595 // it to be a __va_list_tag*.
7596 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
7597 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007598 if (Type->isArrayType())
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007599 Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type);
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007600 else
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007601 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007602 break;
7603 case 'V': {
7604 char *End;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007605 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7606 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007607 Str = End;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007608
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007609 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
7610 RequiresICE, false);
7611 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007612
7613 // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet.
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00007614 Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00007615 VectorType::GenericVector);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007616 break;
7617 }
Douglas Gregorfed66992012-06-07 18:08:25 +00007618 case 'E': {
7619 char *End;
7620
7621 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7622 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
7623
7624 Str = End;
7625
7626 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
7627 false);
7628 Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
7629 break;
7630 }
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00007631 case 'X': {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007632 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
7633 false);
7634 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE");
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00007635 Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType);
7636 break;
Fariborz Jahanian73952fc2011-08-23 23:33:09 +00007637 }
7638 case 'Y' : {
7639 Type = Context.getPointerDiffType();
7640 break;
7641 }
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00007642 case 'P':
Douglas Gregor27821ce2009-07-07 16:35:42 +00007643 Type = Context.getFILEType();
7644 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007645 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007646 return QualType();
7647 }
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007648 break;
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00007649 case 'J':
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007650 if (Signed)
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00007651 Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType();
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007652 else
7653 Type = Context.getjmp_bufType();
7654
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007655 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007656 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp;
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007657 return QualType();
7658 }
7659 break;
Rafael Espindola6cfa82b2011-11-13 21:51:09 +00007660 case 'K':
7661 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!");
7662 Type = Context.getucontext_tType();
7663
7664 if (Type.isNull()) {
7665 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext;
7666 return QualType();
7667 }
7668 break;
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00007669 case 'p':
7670 Type = Context.getProcessIDType();
7671 break;
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00007672 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007673
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007674 // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it.
7675 Done = !AllowTypeModifiers;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007676 while (!Done) {
John McCallb8b94662010-03-12 04:21:28 +00007677 switch (char c = *Str++) {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007678 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
7679 case '*':
7680 case '&': {
7681 // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types
7682 // qualified with an address space.
7683 char *End;
7684 unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7685 if (End != Str && AddrSpace != 0) {
7686 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, AddrSpace);
7687 Str = End;
7688 }
7689 if (c == '*')
7690 Type = Context.getPointerType(Type);
7691 else
7692 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
7693 break;
7694 }
7695 // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg.
7696 case 'C':
7697 Type = Type.withConst();
7698 break;
7699 case 'D':
7700 Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type);
7701 break;
Ted Kremenekf2a2f5f2012-01-20 21:40:12 +00007702 case 'R':
7703 Type = Type.withRestrict();
7704 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007705 }
7706 }
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007707
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007708 assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) &&
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007709 "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007710
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007711 return Type;
7712}
7713
7714/// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin.
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007715QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007716 GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007717 unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007718 const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.GetTypeString(Id);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007719
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007720 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007721
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007722 bool RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007723 Error = GE_None;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007724 QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error,
7725 RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007726 if (Error != GE_None)
7727 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007728
7729 assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE");
7730
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007731 while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007732 QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007733 if (Error != GE_None)
7734 return QualType();
7735
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007736 // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the
7737 // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return.
7738 if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs)
7739 *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size();
7740
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007741 // Do array -> pointer decay. The builtin should use the decayed type.
7742 if (Ty->isArrayType())
7743 Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007744
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007745 ArgTypes.push_back(Ty);
7746 }
7747
7748 assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) &&
7749 "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!");
7750
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007751 FunctionType::ExtInfo EI(CC_C);
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00007752 if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true);
7753
7754 bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.');
7755
7756 // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here, especially in C++.
7757 if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic)
7758 return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI);
Douglas Gregor36c569f2010-02-21 22:15:06 +00007759
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007760 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00007761 EPI.ExtInfo = EI;
7762 EPI.Variadic = Variadic;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007763
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00007764 return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007765}
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00007766
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007767static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForFunction(const ASTContext &Context,
7768 const FunctionDecl *FD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007769 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007770 return GVA_Internal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007771
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007772 GVALinkage External = GVA_StrongExternal;
7773 switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
7774 case TSK_Undeclared:
7775 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
7776 External = GVA_StrongExternal;
7777 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007778
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007779 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00007780 return GVA_StrongODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007781
David Majnemerc3d07332014-05-15 06:25:57 +00007782 // C++11 [temp.explicit]p10:
7783 // [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of
7784 // an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly
7785 // instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for
7786 // inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be
7787 // generated in the translation unit. -- end note ]
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007788 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007789 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
7790
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007791 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007792 External = GVA_DiscardableODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007793 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007794 }
7795
7796 if (!FD->isInlined())
7797 return External;
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00007798
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007799 if ((!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !Context.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
7800 !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) ||
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00007801 FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007802 // FIXME: This doesn't match gcc's behavior for dllexport inline functions.
7803
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007804 // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be
7805 // externally visible.
7806 if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible())
7807 return External;
7808
7809 // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible.
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007810 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007811 }
7812
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00007813 // Functions specified with extern and inline in -fms-compatibility mode
7814 // forcibly get emitted. While the body of the function cannot be later
7815 // replaced, the function definition cannot be discarded.
7816 if (FD->getMostRecentDecl()->isMSExternInline())
7817 return GVA_StrongODR;
7818
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007819 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007820}
7821
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007822static GVALinkage adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(GVALinkage L, const Decl *D) {
7823 // See http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/xa0d9ste.aspx
7824 // dllexport/dllimport on inline functions.
7825 if (D->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>()) {
7826 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_StrongODR)
7827 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
7828 } else if (D->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) {
7829 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
7830 return GVA_StrongODR;
7831 }
7832 return L;
7833}
7834
7835GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) const {
7836 return adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(basicGVALinkageForFunction(*this, FD),
7837 FD);
7838}
7839
7840static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForVariable(const ASTContext &Context,
7841 const VarDecl *VD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007842 if (!VD->isExternallyVisible())
7843 return GVA_Internal;
7844
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007845 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) {
7846 GVALinkage StaticLocalLinkage = GVA_DiscardableODR;
7847 const DeclContext *LexicalContext = VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod();
7848 while (LexicalContext && !isa<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext))
7849 LexicalContext = LexicalContext->getLexicalParent();
7850
7851 // Let the static local variable inherit it's linkage from the nearest
7852 // enclosing function.
7853 if (LexicalContext)
7854 StaticLocalLinkage =
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007855 Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(cast<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext));
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007856
7857 // GVA_StrongODR function linkage is stronger than what we need,
7858 // downgrade to GVA_DiscardableODR.
7859 // This allows us to discard the variable if we never end up needing it.
7860 return StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_StrongODR ? GVA_DiscardableODR
7861 : StaticLocalLinkage;
7862 }
7863
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00007864 // MSVC treats in-class initialized static data members as definitions.
7865 // By giving them non-strong linkage, out-of-line definitions won't
7866 // cause link errors.
7867 if (Context.isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
7868 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
7869
Richard Smith8809a0c2013-09-27 20:14:12 +00007870 switch (VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007871 case TSK_Undeclared:
7872 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
7873 return GVA_StrongExternal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007874
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007875 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00007876 return GVA_StrongODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007877
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007878 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
7879 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
7880
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007881 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007882 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007883 }
Rafael Espindola27699c82013-05-13 14:05:53 +00007884
7885 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007886}
7887
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007888GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) {
7889 return adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(basicGVALinkageForVariable(*this, VD),
7890 VD);
7891}
7892
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc9049332010-07-29 20:08:05 +00007893bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007894 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
7895 if (!VD->isFileVarDecl())
7896 return false;
Renato Golin9258aa52014-05-21 10:40:27 +00007897 // Global named register variables (GNU extension) are never emitted.
7898 if (VD->getStorageClass() == SC_Register)
7899 return false;
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00007900 } else if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
7901 // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template.
7902 if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
7903 return false;
7904 } else
7905 return false;
7906
7907 // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it.
7908 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007909 return false;
7910
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00007911 // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves.
7912 if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>())
7913 return false;
7914
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007915 // Aliases and used decls are required.
7916 if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
7917 return true;
7918
7919 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
7920 // Forward declarations aren't required.
Alexis Hunt4a8ea102011-05-06 20:44:56 +00007921 if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
Nick Lewycky26da4dd2011-07-18 05:26:13 +00007922 return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007923
7924 // Constructors and destructors are required.
7925 if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>())
7926 return true;
7927
John McCall6bd2a892013-01-25 22:31:03 +00007928 // The key function for a class is required. This rule only comes
7929 // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though.
7930 if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
7931 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
7932 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent();
7933 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) {
7934 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD);
7935 if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl())
7936 return true;
7937 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007938 }
7939 }
7940
7941 GVALinkage Linkage = GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD);
7942
7943 // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can
7944 // always be deferred. Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++.
7945 // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++.
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007946 if (Linkage == GVA_Internal || Linkage == GVA_AvailableExternally ||
7947 Linkage == GVA_DiscardableODR)
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007948 return false;
7949 return true;
7950 }
Douglas Gregor87d81242011-09-10 00:22:34 +00007951
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007952 const VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D);
7953 assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var");
7954
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00007955 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly &&
7956 !isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00007957 return false;
7958
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00007959 // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007960 GVALinkage L = GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD);
David Majnemerc3d07332014-05-15 06:25:57 +00007961 if (L != GVA_Internal && L != GVA_AvailableExternally &&
7962 L != GVA_DiscardableODR)
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00007963 return true;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007964
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00007965 // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required.
7966 if (VD->getType().isDestructedType())
7967 return true;
7968
7969 // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required.
7970 if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this))
7971 return true;
7972
7973 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007974}
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00007975
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007976CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic,
7977 bool IsCXXMethod) const {
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00007978 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007979 if (IsCXXMethod)
7980 return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(IsVariadic);
Timur Iskhodzhanovc5098ad2012-07-12 09:50:54 +00007981
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007982 return (LangOpts.MRTD && !IsVariadic) ? CC_X86StdCall : CC_C;
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00007983}
7984
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007985bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
Anders Carlsson60a62632010-11-25 01:51:53 +00007986 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
7987 return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD);
7988}
7989
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +00007990VTableContextBase *ASTContext::getVTableContext() {
7991 if (!VTContext.get()) {
7992 if (Target->getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
7993 VTContext.reset(new MicrosoftVTableContext(*this));
7994 else
7995 VTContext.reset(new ItaniumVTableContext(*this));
7996 }
7997 return VTContext.get();
7998}
7999
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00008000MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext() {
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008001 switch (Target->getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00008002 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008003 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
8004 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
8005 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +00008006 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00008007 return ItaniumMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008008 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00008009 return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00008010 }
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008011 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00008012}
8013
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00008014CXXABI::~CXXABI() {}
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00008015
8016size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const {
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00008017 return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize() +
8018 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts) +
8019 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions) +
8020 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls) +
8021 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits) +
8022 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs) +
8023 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(TemplateOrInstantiation) +
8024 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl) +
8025 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl) +
8026 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl) +
8027 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods) +
8028 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types) +
8029 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes) +
8030 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ClassScopeSpecializationPattern);
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00008031}
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00008032
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00008033/// getIntTypeForBitwidth -
8034/// sets integer QualTy according to specified details:
8035/// bitwidth, signed/unsigned.
8036/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8037QualType ASTContext::getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,
8038 unsigned Signed) const {
8039 TargetInfo::IntType Ty = getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(DestWidth, Signed);
8040 CanQualType QualTy = getFromTargetType(Ty);
8041 if (!QualTy && DestWidth == 128)
8042 return Signed ? Int128Ty : UnsignedInt128Ty;
8043 return QualTy;
8044}
8045
8046/// getRealTypeForBitwidth -
8047/// sets floating point QualTy according to specified bitwidth.
8048/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8049QualType ASTContext::getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth) const {
8050 TargetInfo::RealType Ty = getTargetInfo().getRealTypeByWidth(DestWidth);
8051 switch (Ty) {
8052 case TargetInfo::Float:
8053 return FloatTy;
8054 case TargetInfo::Double:
8055 return DoubleTy;
8056 case TargetInfo::LongDouble:
8057 return LongDoubleTy;
8058 case TargetInfo::NoFloat:
8059 return QualType();
8060 }
8061
8062 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::RealType value");
8063}
8064
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008065void ASTContext::setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND, unsigned Number) {
8066 if (Number > 1)
8067 MangleNumbers[ND] = Number;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00008068}
8069
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008070unsigned ASTContext::getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND) const {
8071 llvm::DenseMap<const NamedDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8072 MangleNumbers.find(ND);
8073 return I != MangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00008074}
8075
David Majnemer2206bf52014-03-05 08:57:59 +00008076void ASTContext::setStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD, unsigned Number) {
8077 if (Number > 1)
8078 StaticLocalNumbers[VD] = Number;
8079}
8080
8081unsigned ASTContext::getStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD) const {
8082 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8083 StaticLocalNumbers.find(VD);
8084 return I != StaticLocalNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
8085}
8086
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008087MangleNumberingContext &
8088ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC) {
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00008089 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus); // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C.
8090 MangleNumberingContext *&MCtx = MangleNumberingContexts[DC];
8091 if (!MCtx)
8092 MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext();
8093 return *MCtx;
8094}
8095
8096MangleNumberingContext *ASTContext::createMangleNumberingContext() const {
8097 return ABI->createMangleNumberingContext();
Douglas Gregor63798542012-02-20 19:44:39 +00008098}
8099
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00008100void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) {
8101 ParamIndices[D] = index;
8102}
8103
8104unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const {
8105 ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D);
8106 assert(I != ParamIndices.end() &&
8107 "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl");
8108 return I->second;
8109}
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008110
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00008111APValue *
8112ASTContext::getMaterializedTemporaryValue(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *E,
8113 bool MayCreate) {
8114 assert(E && E->getStorageDuration() == SD_Static &&
8115 "don't need to cache the computed value for this temporary");
8116 if (MayCreate)
8117 return &MaterializedTemporaryValues[E];
8118
8119 llvm::DenseMap<const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *, APValue>::iterator I =
8120 MaterializedTemporaryValues.find(E);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00008121 return I == MaterializedTemporaryValues.end() ? nullptr : &I->second;
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00008122}
8123
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008124bool ASTContext::AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr *E) const {
8125 const llvm::Triple &T = getTargetInfo().getTriple();
8126 if (!T.isOSDarwin())
8127 return false;
8128
Bob Wilson2c82c3d2013-11-02 23:27:49 +00008129 if (!(T.isiOS() && T.isOSVersionLT(7)) &&
8130 !(T.isMacOSX() && T.isOSVersionLT(10, 9)))
8131 return false;
8132
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008133 QualType AtomicTy = E->getPtr()->getType()->getPointeeType();
8134 CharUnits sizeChars = getTypeSizeInChars(AtomicTy);
8135 uint64_t Size = sizeChars.getQuantity();
8136 CharUnits alignChars = getTypeAlignInChars(AtomicTy);
8137 unsigned Align = alignChars.getQuantity();
8138 unsigned MaxInlineWidthInBits = getTargetInfo().getMaxAtomicInlineWidth();
8139 return (Size != Align || toBits(sizeChars) > MaxInlineWidthInBits);
8140}
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008141
8142namespace {
8143
8144 /// \brief A \c RecursiveASTVisitor that builds a map from nodes to their
8145 /// parents as defined by the \c RecursiveASTVisitor.
8146 ///
8147 /// Note that the relationship described here is purely in terms of AST
8148 /// traversal - there are other relationships (for example declaration context)
8149 /// in the AST that are better modeled by special matchers.
8150 ///
8151 /// FIXME: Currently only builds up the map using \c Stmt and \c Decl nodes.
8152 class ParentMapASTVisitor : public RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> {
8153
8154 public:
8155 /// \brief Builds and returns the translation unit's parent map.
8156 ///
8157 /// The caller takes ownership of the returned \c ParentMap.
8158 static ASTContext::ParentMap *buildMap(TranslationUnitDecl &TU) {
8159 ParentMapASTVisitor Visitor(new ASTContext::ParentMap);
8160 Visitor.TraverseDecl(&TU);
8161 return Visitor.Parents;
8162 }
8163
8164 private:
8165 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> VisitorBase;
8166
8167 ParentMapASTVisitor(ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents) : Parents(Parents) {
8168 }
8169
8170 bool shouldVisitTemplateInstantiations() const {
8171 return true;
8172 }
8173 bool shouldVisitImplicitCode() const {
8174 return true;
8175 }
8176 // Disables data recursion. We intercept Traverse* methods in the RAV, which
8177 // are not triggered during data recursion.
8178 bool shouldUseDataRecursionFor(clang::Stmt *S) const {
8179 return false;
8180 }
8181
8182 template <typename T>
8183 bool TraverseNode(T *Node, bool(VisitorBase:: *traverse) (T *)) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00008184 if (!Node)
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008185 return true;
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008186 if (ParentStack.size() > 0) {
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00008187 // FIXME: Currently we add the same parent multiple times, but only
8188 // when no memoization data is available for the type.
8189 // For example when we visit all subexpressions of template
8190 // instantiations; this is suboptimal, but benign: the only way to
8191 // visit those is with hasAncestor / hasParent, and those do not create
8192 // new matches.
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008193 // The plan is to enable DynTypedNode to be storable in a map or hash
8194 // map. The main problem there is to implement hash functions /
8195 // comparison operators for all types that DynTypedNode supports that
8196 // do not have pointer identity.
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008197 auto &NodeOrVector = (*Parents)[Node];
8198 if (NodeOrVector.isNull()) {
8199 NodeOrVector = new ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008200 } else {
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00008201 if (NodeOrVector.template is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
8202 auto *Node =
8203 NodeOrVector.template get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
8204 auto *Vector = new ASTContext::ParentVector(1, *Node);
8205 NodeOrVector = Vector;
8206 delete Node;
8207 }
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008208 assert(NodeOrVector.template is<ASTContext::ParentVector *>());
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00008209
8210 auto *Vector =
8211 NodeOrVector.template get<ASTContext::ParentVector *>();
8212 // Skip duplicates for types that have memoization data.
8213 // We must check that the type has memoization data before calling
8214 // std::find() because DynTypedNode::operator== can't compare all
8215 // types.
8216 bool Found = ParentStack.back().getMemoizationData() &&
8217 std::find(Vector->begin(), Vector->end(),
8218 ParentStack.back()) != Vector->end();
8219 if (!Found)
8220 Vector->push_back(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008221 }
8222 }
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008223 ParentStack.push_back(ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*Node));
8224 bool Result = (this ->* traverse) (Node);
8225 ParentStack.pop_back();
8226 return Result;
8227 }
8228
8229 bool TraverseDecl(Decl *DeclNode) {
8230 return TraverseNode(DeclNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseDecl);
8231 }
8232
8233 bool TraverseStmt(Stmt *StmtNode) {
8234 return TraverseNode(StmtNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseStmt);
8235 }
8236
8237 ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents;
8238 llvm::SmallVector<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode, 16> ParentStack;
8239
8240 friend class RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor>;
8241 };
8242
8243} // end namespace
8244
8245ASTContext::ParentVector
8246ASTContext::getParents(const ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode &Node) {
8247 assert(Node.getMemoizationData() &&
8248 "Invariant broken: only nodes that support memoization may be "
8249 "used in the parent map.");
8250 if (!AllParents) {
8251 // We always need to run over the whole translation unit, as
8252 // hasAncestor can escape any subtree.
8253 AllParents.reset(
8254 ParentMapASTVisitor::buildMap(*getTranslationUnitDecl()));
8255 }
8256 ParentMap::const_iterator I = AllParents->find(Node.getMemoizationData());
8257 if (I == AllParents->end()) {
8258 return ParentVector();
8259 }
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008260 if (I->second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
8261 return ParentVector(1, *I->second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>());
8262 }
8263 const auto &Parents = *I->second.get<ParentVector *>();
8264 return ParentVector(Parents.begin(), Parents.end());
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008265}
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00008266
8267bool
8268ASTContext::ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl,
8269 const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodImpl) {
8270 // No point trying to match an unavailable/deprecated mothod.
8271 if (MethodDecl->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()
8272 || MethodDecl->hasAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
8273 return false;
8274 if (MethodDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier() !=
8275 MethodImpl->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8276 return false;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008277 if (!hasSameType(MethodDecl->getReturnType(), MethodImpl->getReturnType()))
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00008278 return false;
8279
8280 if (MethodDecl->param_size() != MethodImpl->param_size())
8281 return false;
8282
8283 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator IM = MethodImpl->param_begin(),
8284 IF = MethodDecl->param_begin(), EM = MethodImpl->param_end(),
8285 EF = MethodDecl->param_end();
8286 IM != EM && IF != EF; ++IM, ++IF) {
8287 const ParmVarDecl *DeclVar = (*IF);
8288 const ParmVarDecl *ImplVar = (*IM);
8289 if (ImplVar->getObjCDeclQualifier() != DeclVar->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8290 return false;
8291 if (!hasSameType(DeclVar->getType(), ImplVar->getType()))
8292 return false;
8293 }
8294 return (MethodDecl->isVariadic() == MethodImpl->isVariadic());
8295
8296}
Richard Smith053f6c62014-05-16 23:01:30 +00008297
8298// Explicitly instantiate this in case a Redeclarable<T> is used from a TU that
8299// doesn't include ASTContext.h
8300template
8301clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
8302 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::ValueType
8303clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
8304 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::makeValue(
8305 const clang::ASTContext &Ctx, Decl *Value);